blob: 81067dca4d834b4b6bdb420ebfb985258269f26d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaubab84d42014-12-31 22:22:28 +01005 version 1.5.10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaubab84d42014-12-31 22:22:28 +01007 2014/12/31
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100660ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
662 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
663 keyword to see available options.
664
665 Example:
666 global
667 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
668
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
671 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100673 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
674 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
675 information.
676
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100677ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
679 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
680 keyword to see available options.
681
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100682ssl-server-verify [none|required]
683 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
684 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
685 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
686
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200687stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
688 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
689 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
690 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
691 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
694 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
695 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200696
697stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
698 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
699 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100700 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200701
702stats maxconn <connections>
703 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
704 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706uid <number>
707 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
708 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
709 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
710 one. See also "gid" and "user".
711
712ulimit-n <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
714 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
715 option.
716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100717unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
718 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
719
720 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
721 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
722 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
723 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
724 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
725 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
726 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
727 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
728 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
729 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731user <user name>
732 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
733 See also "uid" and "group".
734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200735node <name>
736 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
737
738 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
739 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
740 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
741 traffic.
742
743description <text>
744 Add a text that describes the instance.
745
746 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
747 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
748 "<" and ">" characters.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752-----------------------
753
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200754max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
755 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
756 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
757 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
758 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
759 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
760 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
761 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
762 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764maxconn <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
766 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
767 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200768 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
769 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
770 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
771 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
772 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200774maxconnrate <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
776 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
777 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
778 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
779 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
780 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
781 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
782 fairness.
783
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100784maxcomprate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300786 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100787 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
788 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
789 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
790 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
791 default value.
792
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100793maxcompcpuusage <number>
794 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
795 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
796 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
797 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
798 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
799 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
800 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
801 process down and from introducing high latencies.
802
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100803maxpipes <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
805 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
806 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
807 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
808 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
809 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200811maxsessrate <number>
812 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
813 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
814 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
815 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
816 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
817 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
818 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
819 fairness.
820
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200821maxsslconn <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
823 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
824 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
825 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
826 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
827 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
828 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
829
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200830maxsslrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
832 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
833 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
834 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
835 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
836 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
837 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
838 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
839 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
840 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
841
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100842maxzlibmem <number>
843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
844 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
845 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100846 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
847 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
848 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850noepoll
851 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
852 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100853 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
855nokqueue
856 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
857 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
858 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
859
860nopoll
861 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
862 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100863 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100864 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100866nosplice
867 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
868 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
869 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100870 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100871 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
872 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
873 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
874 "option splice-response".
875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300876nogetaddrinfo
877 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
878 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
879
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200880spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900881 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
882 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
883 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
884 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
885 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
886 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200887
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200888tune.bufsize <number>
889 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
890 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
891 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
892 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
893 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
894 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
895 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
896 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400897 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200901tune.chksize <number>
902 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
903 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
904 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
905 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
906 checks whenever possible.
907
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100908tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
909 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
910 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
911 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
912 this value. The default value is 1.
913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100914tune.http.cookielen <number>
915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
922 to change this value.
923
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200924tune.http.maxhdr <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
926 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
927 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
928 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
929 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
930 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
931 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
932 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
933 limit too high.
934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100935tune.idletimer <timeout>
936 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
941 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
943 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
945
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100946tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100947 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
948 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
949 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
950 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
951 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
952 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
953 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
954 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
955 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
956 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100957
958tune.maxpollevents <number>
959 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
960 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
961 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
962 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
963 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
964
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200965tune.maxrewrite <number>
966 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
967 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
968 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
969 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
970 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
971 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
972 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
973 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
974 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
975 bufsize.
976
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200977tune.pipesize <number>
978 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
979 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
980 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
981 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
982 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
983 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
984
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100985tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
986tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
987 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
988 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
989 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
990 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
991 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
992 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
993 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
994
995tune.sndbuf.client <number>
996tune.sndbuf.server <number>
997 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
998 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
999 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1000 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1001 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1002 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1003 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1004 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1005 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1006 notifying haproxy again.
1007
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001009 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1010 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1011 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001012 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001013 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1014 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1015 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1016 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1017 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001018 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1019 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001021tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1022 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1023 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1024 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1025 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1026 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1027 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1028
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001029tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1030 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001031 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001032 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1033 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1034 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1035 being used for too long.
1036
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001037tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1038 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1039 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1040 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1041 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1042 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1043 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1044 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1045 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1046 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1047 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001048 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1049 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001050
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001051tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1052 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1053 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1054 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1055 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1056 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1057 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1058 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1059 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1060
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001061tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1062 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001063 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001064 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1065 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1066 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1067
1068tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1069 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1070 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1071 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1072 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010743.3. Debugging
1075--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077debug
1078 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1079 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1080 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1081 system startup.
1082
1083quiet
1084 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1085 line argument "-q".
1086
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010883.4. Userlists
1089--------------
1090It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1091http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1092it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1093
1094userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001095 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001096 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1097
1098group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001100 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1101 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1102
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001103user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1104 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1106 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1108 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001110 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
1112
1113 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L1
1115 group G1 users tiger,scott
1116 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001122 userlist L2
1123 group G1
1124 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1127 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1128 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
1130 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001132
11333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001134----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1136haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1137pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1138identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1139or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1140Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1141known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1142the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1143process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1144during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1145tables.
1146
1147peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001148 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001149 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1150
1151peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1152 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1153 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1154 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1155 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1156 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1157 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1158
1159 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1160 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1161
1162 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1163 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1164 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1165 across all peers.
1166
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001167 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1168 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1169 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1170
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001171 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001173 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1174 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1175 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001176
1177 backend mybackend
1178 mode tcp
1179 balance roundrobin
1180 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1181 stick on src
1182
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001183 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1184 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001185
1186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001190Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1191 - defaults <name>
1192 - frontend <name>
1193 - backend <name>
1194 - listen <name>
1195
1196A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1197its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1198section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001199section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001200
1201A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1202connections.
1203
1204A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1205to forward incoming connections.
1206
1207A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1208parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1211'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1212case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1213
1214Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1215logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1216proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1217However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1218name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1219
1220Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1221and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001222bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001223protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1224modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1225arbitrary criteria.
1226
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001227In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1228a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1229the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1230
1231 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1232 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1233 between responses and new requests.
1234
1235 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1236 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1237 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1238 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1239
1240 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1241 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1242 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1243
1244 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1245 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1246 client-facing connection remains open.
1247
1248 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1249 after the end of the response.
1250
1251The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1252frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1253following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1254weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1255
1256 Backend mode
1257
1258 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1261 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1262 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1263 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1264 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1265 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1266 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1273--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001275The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1276limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1277they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1278limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001280option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001281and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1282with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1283specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001284
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001285
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1287------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1288acl - X X X
1289appsession - - X X
1290backlog X X X -
1291balance X - X X
1292bind - X X -
1293bind-process X X X X
1294block - X X X
1295capture cookie - X X -
1296capture request header - X X -
1297capture response header - X X -
1298clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001299compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1301cookie X - X X
1302default-server X - X X
1303default_backend X X X -
1304description - X X X
1305disabled X X X X
1306dispatch - - X X
1307enabled X X X X
1308errorfile X X X X
1309errorloc X X X X
1310errorloc302 X X X X
1311-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1312errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001313force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314fullconn X - X X
1315grace X X X X
1316hash-type X - X X
1317http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001318http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001319http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001321http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001322http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001323id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001324ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001325log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001326max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001327maxconn X X X -
1328mode X X X X
1329monitor fail - X X -
1330monitor-net X X X -
1331monitor-uri X X X -
1332option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1333option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1334option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1335option allbackups (*) X - X X
1336option checkcache (*) X - X X
1337option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1338option contstats (*) X X X -
1339option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1340option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1341option forceclose (*) X X X X
1342-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1343option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001344option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001345option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001346option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001347option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001348option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001349option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1350option httpchk X - X X
1351option httpclose (*) X X X X
1352option httplog X X X X
1353option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001354option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001355option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001356option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1357option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1358option logasap (*) X X X -
1359option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001360option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001361option nolinger (*) X X X X
1362option originalto X X X X
1363option persist (*) X - X X
1364option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001365option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001366option smtpchk X - X X
1367option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1368option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1369option splice-request (*) X X X X
1370option splice-response (*) X X X X
1371option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1372option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1373-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001374option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001375option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1376option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1377option tcpka X X X X
1378option tcplog X X X X
1379option transparent (*) X - X X
1380persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1381rate-limit sessions X X X -
1382redirect - X X X
1383redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1384redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1385reqadd - X X X
1386reqallow - X X X
1387reqdel - X X X
1388reqdeny - X X X
1389reqiallow - X X X
1390reqidel - X X X
1391reqideny - X X X
1392reqipass - X X X
1393reqirep - X X X
1394reqisetbe - X X X
1395reqitarpit - X X X
1396reqpass - X X X
1397reqrep - X X X
1398-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1399reqsetbe - X X X
1400reqtarpit - X X X
1401retries X - X X
1402rspadd - X X X
1403rspdel - X X X
1404rspdeny - X X X
1405rspidel - X X X
1406rspideny - X X X
1407rspirep - X X X
1408rsprep - X X X
1409server - - X X
1410source X - X X
1411srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001412stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001413stats auth X - X X
1414stats enable X - X X
1415stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001416stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001417stats realm X - X X
1418stats refresh X - X X
1419stats scope X - X X
1420stats show-desc X - X X
1421stats show-legends X - X X
1422stats show-node X - X X
1423stats uri X - X X
1424-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1425stick match - - X X
1426stick on - - X X
1427stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001428stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001429stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001430tcp-check connect - - X X
1431tcp-check expect - - X X
1432tcp-check send - - X X
1433tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001434tcp-request connection - X X -
1435tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001436tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001437tcp-response content - - X X
1438tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001439timeout check X - X X
1440timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001441timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001442timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1443timeout connect X - X X
1444timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1445timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1446timeout http-request X X X X
1447timeout queue X - X X
1448timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001449timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001450timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1451timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001452timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001454unique-id-format X X X -
1455unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001456use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001457use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001458------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1459 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1463---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001464
1465This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1466
1467
1468acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1469 Declare or complete an access list.
1470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1471 no | yes | yes | yes
1472 Example:
1473 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1474 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1475 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001477 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001478
1479
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001480appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1481 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001482 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1484 no | no | yes | yes
1485 Arguments :
1486 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1487 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1488
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001489 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001490 checked in each cookie value.
1491
1492 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1493 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1494 milliseconds.
1495
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001496 request-learn
1497 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1498 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1499 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1500 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1501 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1502 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1503
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001504 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1505 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1506 data following this prefix.
1507
1508 Example :
1509 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1510
1511 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1512 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1513
1514 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1515 2 modes are currently supported :
1516 - path-parameters :
1517 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1518 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1519 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1520 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1521 - query-string :
1522 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1523 query string.
1524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001525 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1526 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1527 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1528 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001529 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1530 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1531 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1533 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1534
1535 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1536
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001537 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1538 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1539 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541 Example :
1542 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1543
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001544 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1545 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001546
1547
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001548backlog <conns>
1549 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1551 yes | yes | yes | no
1552 Arguments :
1553 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1554 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001555 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001556
1557 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1558 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1559 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1560 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1561 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1562 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1563 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1564 backlog parameter.
1565
1566 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1567 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1568 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1569
1570 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1571
1572
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001574balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001575 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1577 yes | no | yes | yes
1578 Arguments :
1579 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1580 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1581 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1582 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1583
1584 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1585 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1586 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1587 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001588 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001589 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001590 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1591 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1592 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1593 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1594 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1595 it, so that you don't worry.
1596
1597 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1598 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1599 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1600 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1601 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1602 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1603 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1604 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001605
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001606 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1607 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1608 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1609 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1610 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1611 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1612 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1613 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1614
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001615 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001616 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001617 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1618 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001619 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001620 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1621 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1622 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1623 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1624 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001625 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1626 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1627 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1628 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1629 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1630 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1633 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1634 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1635 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1636 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1637 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1638 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1639 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001640 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001642 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1643 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1644 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001645
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001646 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1647 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1648 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1649 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1650 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1651 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1652 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1653 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1654 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1655 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1656 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1657 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001658
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001659 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001660 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1661 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1662 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1663 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1664 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1665 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1666 URIs start with a leading "/".
1667
1668 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1669 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1670 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1671 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001673 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001674 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1675
1676 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001677 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1678 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001679 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1680 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1681 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1682 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001683 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001684 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1685 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001686
1687 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1688 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1689 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1690 server will receive the request.
1691
1692 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1693 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1694 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1695 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1696 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001697 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1698 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1699 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001701 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1702 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1703 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1704 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1705 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001707 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001708 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1709 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1710 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1711
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001712 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1713 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1714 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1715
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001716 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001717 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001718 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1719 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1720 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1721 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1722 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1723 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001724 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001725 used instead.
1726
1727 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1728 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1729 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1730 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1731
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001732 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1733 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1734 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1735
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001736 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001737
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001738 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001739 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1740 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001741
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001742 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1743 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1744 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745
1746 Examples :
1747 balance roundrobin
1748 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001749 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001750 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1751 balance hdr(host)
1752 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001753
1754 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1755 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001757 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001758 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1759 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1760 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1761 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1762
1763 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1764 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1765 defaults to 16 kB.
1766
1767 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1768 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1769
1770 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1771 Round Robin.
1772
1773 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1774 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1775 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1776 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1777
1778 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1779
1780 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001781 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001782 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1783 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1784 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001786 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1787 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001788
1789
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001790bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1791bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001792 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1794 no | yes | yes | no
1795 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001796 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1797 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1798 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1799 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001800 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001801 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1802 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1803 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1804 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1805 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1806 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1807 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001808 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1809 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1810 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1811 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1812 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1813 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1814 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001815 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1816 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1817 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001818 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1819 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1820 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1821 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001822
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001823 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1824 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001825 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1826 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1827 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001828 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1829 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1830 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1831 the range.
1832
1833 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1834 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1835 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1836 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1837 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1838 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1839 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001840 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001841 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001842
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001843 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1844 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1845 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1846 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1847 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1848 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1849 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1850 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1851
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001852 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1853 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1854 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1855 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1858 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1859 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1860 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1861 in a frontend.
1862
1863 Example :
1864 listen http_proxy
1865 bind :80,:443
1866 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001867 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001868
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001869 listen http_https_proxy
1870 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001871 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001872
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001873 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1874 bind ipv6@:80
1875 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1876 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1877
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001878 listen external_bind_app1
1879 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1880
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001881 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001882 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883
1884
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001885bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001886 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1888 yes | yes | yes | yes
1889 Arguments :
1890 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1891 may be used to override a default value.
1892
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001893 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001894 option may be combined with other numbers.
1895
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001896 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001897 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1898 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1899 missing from all processes.
1900
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001901 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001902 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001903 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1904 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1905 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1906 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001907
1908 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1909 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1910 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1911 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1912 and 'even' instances.
1913
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001914 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1915 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1916 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1917 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001918
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001919 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1920 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1921
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001922 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1923 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1924 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1925
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001926 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1927 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1928
1929 Example :
1930 listen app_ip1
1931 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001932 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001933
1934 listen app_ip2
1935 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001936 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001937
1938 listen management
1939 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001940 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001941
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001942 listen management
1943 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1944 bind-process 1-4
1945
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001946 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001947
1948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949block { if | unless } <condition>
1950 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1952 no | yes | yes | yes
1953
1954 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1955 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001956 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001957 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001958 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1959 "block" statements per instance.
1960
1961 Example:
1962 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1963 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1964 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1965 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001967 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001968
1969
1970capture cookie <name> len <length>
1971 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1973 no | yes | yes | no
1974 Arguments :
1975 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1976 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1977 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1978 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1979 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1980
1981 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1982 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1983 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1984 right if it exceeds <length>.
1985
1986 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1987 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1988 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1989 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1990
1991 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1992 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1993 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1994
1995 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1996 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1997 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001998 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1999 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2000 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001
2002 Example:
2003 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2004
2005 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002006 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
2008
2009capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002010 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2012 no | yes | yes | no
2013 Arguments :
2014 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002015 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2017 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2018 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2019
2020 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2021 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2022 it exceeds <length>.
2023
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002024 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002025 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2026 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002027 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2028 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2029 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2030 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002031 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002032 environments to find where the request came from.
2033
2034 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2035 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2036 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2037 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002039 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2040 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2041 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2042 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2043 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002044
2045 Example:
2046 capture request header Host len 15
2047 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2048 capture request header Referrer len 15
2049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002050 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002051 about logging.
2052
2053
2054capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002055 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2057 no | yes | yes | no
2058 Arguments :
2059 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002060 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2062 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2063 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2064
2065 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2066 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2067 it exceeds <length>.
2068
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002069 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2071 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2072 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002073 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2074 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2075 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2076 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002078 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2079 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2080 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2081 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2082 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
2084 Example:
2085 capture response header Content-length len 9
2086 capture response header Location len 15
2087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002088 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089 about logging.
2090
2091
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002092clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2095 yes | yes | yes | no
2096 Arguments :
2097 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2098 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2099 as explained at the top of this document.
2100
2101 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2102 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2103 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2104 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2105 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2106 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2107 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2108 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002109 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002110 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2111 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2112
2113 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2114 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2115 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2116 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2117 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2118 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2119
2120 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2121 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2122
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002123 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2124 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002125
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002126compression algo <algorithm> ...
2127compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002128compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002129 Enable HTTP compression.
2130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2131 yes | yes | yes | yes
2132 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002133 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2134 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2135 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2136
2137 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002138 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002139 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2140 data.
2141
2142 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2143 support for zlib was built in.
2144
2145 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2146 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2147 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2148 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2149 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2150 in.
2151
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002152 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002153 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002154 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2155 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2156 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2157 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2158 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002159
2160 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2161 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2162 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2163 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2164 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002165 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2166 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2167 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2168 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2169 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002170 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2171 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002172
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002173 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002174 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2175 "Accept-Encoding" header
2176 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002177 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002178 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2179 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002180 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2181 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2182 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2183 "multipart"
2184 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2185 header
2186 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2187 and later
2188 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2189 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002190
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002191 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2192 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002193
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002194 Examples :
2195 compression algo gzip
2196 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002197
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002198contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2201 yes | no | yes | yes
2202 Arguments :
2203 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2204 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2205 as explained at the top of this document.
2206
2207 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002208 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002209 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002210 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2211 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2212 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2213 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2214
2215 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2216 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2217 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2218 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2219 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2220 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2221
2222 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2223 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2224 instead.
2225
2226 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2227 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2228
2229
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002230cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002231 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2232 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002233 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2235 yes | no | yes | yes
2236 Arguments :
2237 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2238 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2239 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2240 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2241 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2242 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2243 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2244 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2245 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2246
2247 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2248 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2249 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2250 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2251 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2252 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2253 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2254 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2255 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2256 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2257 "insert" and "prefix".
2258
2259 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002260 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002261
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002262 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002263 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2264 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2265 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2266 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2267 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2268 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2269 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2270 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2271 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2272 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002273
2274 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2275 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2276 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2277 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2278 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2279 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2280 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2281 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2282 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2283 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002284 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2285 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2286 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002287
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002288 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2289 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2290 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002291 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2292 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2293 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2294 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002295 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2296 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2297 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298
2299 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2300 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2301 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2302 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2303 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2304 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2305 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2306 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2307 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2308
2309 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2310 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2311 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2312 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2313 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2314 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2315 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2316 persistence cookie in the cache.
2317 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2318
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002319 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2320 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2321 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2322 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2323 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2324 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2325 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2326 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2327 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2328 they logout.
2329
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002330 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2331 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2332 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2333 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2334
2335 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2336 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2337 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2338 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2339 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2340 this attribute.
2341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002342 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002343 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002344 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2345 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2346 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2347 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2348 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2349 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002350
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002351 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2352 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2353 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2354 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2355 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2356 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2357 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2358 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2359 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2360 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2361 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2362 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2363 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2364 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2365 the site.
2366
2367 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2368 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2369 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2370 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2371 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2372 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2373 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2374 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2375 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2376 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2377 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2378 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2379 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2380 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2381 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2382 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2385 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2386 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2387 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389 Examples :
2390 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2391 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2392 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002393 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002394
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002395 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002396 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002397
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002399default-server [param*]
2400 Change default options for a server in a backend
2401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2402 yes | no | yes | yes
2403 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002404 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2405 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2406 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2407 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002408
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002409 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002410 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2411
2412 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002413
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002415default_backend <backend>
2416 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2418 yes | yes | yes | no
2419 Arguments :
2420 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2421
2422 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2423 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2424 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2425 will catch all undetermined requests.
2426
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002427 Example :
2428
2429 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2430 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2431 default_backend dynamic
2432
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002433 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2434
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002435
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002436description <string>
2437 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2439 no | yes | yes | yes
2440 Arguments : string
2441
2442 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2443 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2444 it describes.
2445 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2446
2447
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002448disabled
2449 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 yes | yes | yes | yes
2452 Arguments : none
2453
2454 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2455 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2456 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2457 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2458 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2459 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2460 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2461
2462 See also : "enabled"
2463
2464
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002465dispatch <address>:<port>
2466 Set a default server address
2467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2468 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002469 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002470
2471 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2472 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2473 during start-up.
2474
2475 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2476 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2477 possible with normal servers.
2478
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002479 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002480 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2481 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2482 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2483 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2484
2485 See also : "server"
2486
2487
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002488enabled
2489 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2491 yes | yes | yes | yes
2492 Arguments : none
2493
2494 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2495 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2496
2497 See also : "disabled"
2498
2499
2500errorfile <code> <file>
2501 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2503 yes | yes | yes | yes
2504 Arguments :
2505 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002506 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002507
2508 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002509 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002511 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2512 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002513
2514 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2515 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2516 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2517
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002518 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002520 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2521 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2522 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2523 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2524
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002525 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2526 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2527 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2528 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2529 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2530 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2531
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002532 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2533 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2534 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002535 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2537
2538 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2539
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002540 Example :
2541 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002542 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002543 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2544 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2545
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002546
2547errorloc <code> <url>
2548errorloc302 <code> <url>
2549 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2551 yes | yes | yes | yes
2552 Arguments :
2553 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002554 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002555
2556 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2557 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2558 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2559 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2560 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2561
2562 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2563 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2564 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2565
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002566 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002568 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2569 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2570 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2571 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2572 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2573 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2574 request.
2575
2576 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2577
2578
2579errorloc303 <code> <url>
2580 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 yes | yes | yes | yes
2583 Arguments :
2584 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2585 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2586
2587 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2588 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2589 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2590 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2591 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2592
2593 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2594 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2595 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2596
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002597 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2598
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002599 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2600 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2601 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2602 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002603 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002604
2605 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2606
2607
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002608force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2609 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2611 no | yes | yes | yes
2612
2613 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2614 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2615 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2616 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2617 marked down for maintenance operations.
2618
2619 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2620 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2621 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2622 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2623 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2624 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2625 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2626 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2627 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2628
2629 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2630 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2631 is used.
2632
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002633 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002634 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002635
2636
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002637fullconn <conns>
2638 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2640 yes | no | yes | yes
2641 Arguments :
2642 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2643 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2644
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002645 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002647 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002648 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2649 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2650 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2651 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2652 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002653 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002654
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002655 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2656 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002657 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2658 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2659 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002660
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002661 Example :
2662 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2663 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2664 # connections.
2665 backend dynamic
2666 fullconn 10000
2667 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2668 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2669
2670 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2671
2672
2673grace <time>
2674 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002676 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002677 Arguments :
2678 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2679 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2680 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2681
2682 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2683 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002684 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002685 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2686
2687 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2688 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2689 simplify it.
2690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002692hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002693 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2695 yes | no | yes | yes
2696 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002697 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2698 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002699
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002700 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2701 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2702 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2703 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2704 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2705 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2706 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2707 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2708 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2709 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002710
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002711 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2712 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2713 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2714 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2715 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2716 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2717 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2718 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2719 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2720 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2721 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2722 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2723 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002724 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2725 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002726
2727 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2728
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002729 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002730 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2731 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2732 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002733 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2734 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2735 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002736
2737 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2738 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002739 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2740 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2741 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2742 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2743
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002744 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2745 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2746 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2747 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2748 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2749 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2750 parameter.
2751
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002752 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2753
2754 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2755 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2756 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2757 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2758 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2759 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2760 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2761 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2762 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2763 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2764 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2765 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002766
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002767 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2768 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2769 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002770
2771 See also : "balance", "server"
2772
2773
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002774http-check disable-on-404
2775 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002777 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 Arguments : none
2779
2780 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2781 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2782 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2783 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2784 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2785 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2786 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2787 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002788 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2789 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2790 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2791
2792 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2793
2794
2795http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002796 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002798 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002799 Arguments :
2800 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2801 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002802 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002803 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2804 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2805 details on the supported keywords.
2806
2807 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2808 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2809 with the usual backslash ('\').
2810
2811 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2812 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2813 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2814 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2815 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2816
2817 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002818 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002819 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2820 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2821 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2822
2823 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002824 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002825 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2826 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2827 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2828 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2829
2830 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002831 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002832 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2833 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2834 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2835 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2836 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2837 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2838 trace).
2839
2840 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002841 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002842 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2843 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2844 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2845 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2846 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2847 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2848
2849 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2850 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2851 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2852 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2853 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2854 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2855 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2856 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2857
2858 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2859 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2860
2861 Examples :
2862 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002863 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002864
2865 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002866 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002867
2868 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002869 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002870
2871 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002872 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002873
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002874 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002875
2876
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002877http-check send-state
2878 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2880 yes | no | yes | yes
2881 Arguments : none
2882
2883 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2884 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2885 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2886 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2887 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2888
2889 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2890 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2891 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2892 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2893 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2894 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2895 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2896 checked in multiple backends.
2897
2898 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2899 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2900
2901 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2902 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2903 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2904 one fails.
2905
2906 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2907 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2908 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2909
2910 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2911 server's queue.
2912
2913 Example of a header received by the application server :
2914 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2915 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2916
2917 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2918
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002919http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002920 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002921 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002922 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2923 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002924 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2925 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2926 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2927 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2928 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2929 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002930 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002931 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2932
2933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 no | yes | yes | yes
2935
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002936 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2937 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2938 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2939 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2940 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002941
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002942 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2943 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2944 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2945
2946 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2947 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2948 are evaluated.
2949
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002950 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2951 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2952 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2953 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2954 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2955 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2956 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2957 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2958 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002959 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002960 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2961
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002962 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2963 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2964 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2965 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2966 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2967
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002968 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2969 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2970 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002971 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2972 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002973
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002974 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2975 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2976 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2977 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2978 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2979 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2980 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2981 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2982
2983 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2984 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2985 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2986 external users.
2987
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002988 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2989 <name>.
2990
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002991 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2992 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2993 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2994 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2995 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2996 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2997 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2998 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
2999
3000 Example:
3001
3002 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3003
3004 applied to:
3005
3006 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3007
3008 outputs:
3009
3010 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3011
3012 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3013
3014 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3015 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3016 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3017 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3018 header.
3019
3020 Example:
3021
3022 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3023
3024 applied to:
3025
3026 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3027
3028 outputs:
3029
3030 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3031
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003032 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3033 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3034 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3035 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3036 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3037 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3038 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3039 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3040
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003041 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3042 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3043 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3044 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3045 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3046 another equipment.
3047
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003048 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3049 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3050 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3051 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3052 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3053 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3054 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3055 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3056
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003057 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3058 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3059 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3060 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3061 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3062 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3063 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3064 admin privileges.
3065
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003066 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3067 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3068 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3069 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3070 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3071 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3072 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3073 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3074
3075 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3076 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3077 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3078 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3079 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3080 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3081
3082 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3083 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3084 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3085 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3086 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3087 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3088
3089 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3090 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3091 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3092 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3093 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3094 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3095 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3096 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3097 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3098
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003099 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3100
3101 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3102 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3103 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3104 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003105
3106 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003107 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3108 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3109 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003110
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003111 http-request allow if nagios
3112 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3113 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3114 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003115
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003116 Example:
3117 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003118 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003119
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003120 Example:
3121 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3122 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3123 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3124 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3125 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3126 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3127 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3128 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3129 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3130
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003131 Example:
3132 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3133 acl add path /addacl
3134 acl del path /delacl
3135
3136 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3137
3138 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3139 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3140
3141 Example:
3142 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3143 acl setmap path /setmap
3144 acl delmap path /delmap
3145
3146 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3147
3148 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3149 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3150
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003151 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3152 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003153
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003154http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003155 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003156 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3157 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003158 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3159 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3160 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3161 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3162 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3163 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003164 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003165 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3166
3167 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3168 no | yes | yes | yes
3169
3170 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3171 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3172 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3173 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3174 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3175 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3176
3177 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3178 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3179 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3180 current section.
3181
3182 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3183 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3184 rules are evaluated.
3185
3186 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3187 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3188 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3189 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3190 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3191 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3192 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3193
3194 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3195 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3196 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3197 external users.
3198
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003199 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3200 <name>.
3201
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003202 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3203 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3204 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3205 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3206 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3207 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3208 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3209 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3210
3211 Example:
3212
3213 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3214
3215 applied to:
3216
3217 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3218
3219 outputs:
3220
3221 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3222
3223 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3224
3225 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3226 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3227 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3228 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3229 header.
3230
3231 Example:
3232
3233 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3234
3235 applied to:
3236
3237 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3238
3239 outputs:
3240
3241 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3242
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003243 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3244 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3245 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3246 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3247 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3248 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3249 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3250 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3251
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003252 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3253 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3254 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3255 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3256 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3257 another equipment.
3258
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003259 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3260 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3261 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3262 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3263 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3264 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3265 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3266 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3267
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003268 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3269 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3270 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3271 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3272 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3273 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3274 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3275 admin privileges.
3276
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003277 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3278 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3279 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3280 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3281 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3282 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3283 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3284 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3285
3286 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3287 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3288 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3289 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3290 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3291 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3292
3293 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3294 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3295 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3296 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3297 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3298 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3299
3300 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3301 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3302 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3303 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3304 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3305 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3306 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3307 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3308 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3309
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003310 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3311
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003312 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003313 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3314 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3315 rules.
3316
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003317 Example:
3318 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3319
3320 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3321
3322 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3323 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3324
3325 Example:
3326 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3327
3328 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3329
3330 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3331 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3332
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003333 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3334 ACL usage.
3335
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003336
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003337http-send-name-header [<header>]
3338 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3339
3340 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3341 yes | no | yes | yes
3342
3343 Arguments :
3344
3345 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3346
3347 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3348 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3349 is added with the header string proved.
3350
3351 See also : "server"
3352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003353id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003354 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 no | yes | yes | yes
3357 Arguments : none
3358
3359 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3360 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3361 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003362
3363
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003364ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3365 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3366 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3367 no | yes | yes | yes
3368
3369 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3370 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3371 and running).
3372
3373 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3374 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3375 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003376 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003377 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3378
3379 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3380 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3381
3382 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3383 "unless" condition is met.
3384
3385 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3386
3387
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003388log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003389log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003390no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003391 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3393 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003394
3395 Prefix :
3396 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3397 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3398 prefix does not allow arguments.
3399
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003400 Arguments :
3401 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3402 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3403 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3404 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3405 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3406 parameter.
3407
3408 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3409 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3410
3411 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3412 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3413 standard syslog port).
3414
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003415 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3416 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3417 standard syslog port).
3418
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003419 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3420 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3421 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3422 appropriately writeable).
3423
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003424 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3425 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3426 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3427 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3428
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003429 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3430 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3431 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3432 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3433 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3434 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3435 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3436 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3437 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3438 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3439 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3440
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003441 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3442
3443 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3444 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3445 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3446
3447 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3448 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3449 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003450 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3451 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3452 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3453 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3454 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003455
3456 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3457
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003458 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3459 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3460 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003461
3462 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3463 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3464 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3465 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3466
3467 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3468 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003469
3470 Example :
3471 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003472 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3473 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003474 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3475
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003476
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003477log-format <string>
3478 Allows you to custom a log line.
3479
3480 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3481
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003482
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003483max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3484 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3485 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3486 yes | no | yes | yes
3487
3488 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3489 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3490 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3491 servers.
3492
3493 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3494 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3495 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3496 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3497 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3498 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3499 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3500 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3501 picking a different server.
3502
3503 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3504 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3505 even if they have to be queued.
3506
3507 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3508 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3509
3510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003511maxconn <conns>
3512 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3514 yes | yes | yes | no
3515 Arguments :
3516 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3517 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3518 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3519 closes.
3520
3521 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3522 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3523 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3524 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3525 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3526 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3527 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3528 properly tuned.
3529
3530 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3531 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3532 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3533
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003534 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3535
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003536 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3537
3538
3539mode { tcp|http|health }
3540 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3542 yes | yes | yes | yes
3543 Arguments :
3544 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3545 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3546 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3547 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3548
3549 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3550 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3551 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3552 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3553 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3554
3555 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003556 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3557 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3558 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3559 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3560 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3561 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3562 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003563
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003564 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3565 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3566 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003567
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003568 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003569 defaults http_instances
3570 mode http
3571
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003572 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003575monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003576 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3578 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 Arguments :
3580 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3581 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003582 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003583 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3584 backend and its backup.
3585
3586 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3587 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3588 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3589 servers in a list of backends.
3590
3591 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3592 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3593 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3594 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3595 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3596 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3597 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003598 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3599 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600
3601 Example:
3602 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003603 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003604 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3605 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3606 monitor-uri /site_alive
3607 monitor fail if site_dead
3608
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003609 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003610
3611
3612monitor-net <source>
3613 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3615 yes | yes | yes | no
3616 Arguments :
3617 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3618 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3619 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3620 followed by a mask.
3621
3622 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3623 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003624 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3626
3627 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3628 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3629 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3630 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003631 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3632 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3633 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003634
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003635 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3636 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3637 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3638 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3639 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3640 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003641
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003642 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3643 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003645 Example :
3646 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3647 frontend www
3648 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3649
3650 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3651
3652
3653monitor-uri <uri>
3654 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | yes | yes | no
3657 Arguments :
3658 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3659 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3660
3661 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3662 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3663 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3664 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3665 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3666 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3667 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3668 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3669
3670 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3671 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3672 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3673 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3674 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3675 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3676
3677 Example :
3678 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3679 frontend www
3680 mode http
3681 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3682
3683 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003686option abortonclose
3687no option abortonclose
3688 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 yes | no | yes | yes
3691 Arguments : none
3692
3693 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3694 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3695 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3696 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003697 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003698 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3699 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3700 encountered while delivering the response.
3701
3702 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3703 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3704 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3705 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3706 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3707 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003708 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003709 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003710 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003711 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3712 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3713 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3714
3715 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3716 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3717 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3718 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3719 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3720 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3721 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3722 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003723 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003724
3725 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3726 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3727
3728 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3729
3730
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003731option accept-invalid-http-request
3732no option accept-invalid-http-request
3733 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3735 yes | yes | yes | no
3736 Arguments : none
3737
3738 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3739 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3740 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3741 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3742 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3743 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3744 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3745 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003746 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3747 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3748 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3749 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3750 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3751 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003752
3753 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3754 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3755 been confirmed.
3756
3757 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3758 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003759 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3760 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003761 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3762
3763 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3764 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3765
3766 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3767 stats socket.
3768
3769
3770option accept-invalid-http-response
3771no option accept-invalid-http-response
3772 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 yes | no | yes | yes
3775 Arguments : none
3776
3777 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3778 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3779 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3780 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3781 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3782 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3783 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3784 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3785 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3786
3787 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3788 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3789 been confirmed.
3790
3791 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3792 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3793 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3794 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3795
3796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3798
3799 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3800 stats socket.
3801
3802
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003803option allbackups
3804no option allbackups
3805 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3807 yes | no | yes | yes
3808 Arguments : none
3809
3810 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3811 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3812 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3813 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3814 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3815 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3816 order between the backup servers anymore.
3817
3818 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3819 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3820
3821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3823
3824
3825option checkcache
3826no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003827 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3829 yes | no | yes | yes
3830 Arguments : none
3831
3832 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3833 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003834 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003835 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3836 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003837 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003838
3839 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003840 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003841 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003842 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3843 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003844 to the client are :
3845 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003846 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003847 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003848 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3849 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3850 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3851 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3852 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3853 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3854 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3855 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3856 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3857 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3858 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3859
3860 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003861 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003862 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003863 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003864 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3865
3866 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3867 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003868 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003869 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3870
3871 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3872 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3873
3874
3875option clitcpka
3876no option clitcpka
3877 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | yes | yes | no
3880 Arguments : none
3881
3882 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3883 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3884 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3885 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3886
3887 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3888 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3889 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3890 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3891
3892 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3893 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3894 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3895 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3896 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3897
3898 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3899
3900 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3901 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3902 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3903
3904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3906
3907 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3908
3909
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003910option contstats
3911 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3913 yes | yes | yes | no
3914 Arguments : none
3915
3916 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3917 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3918 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3919 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3920 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3921 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3922 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3923
3924
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003925option dontlog-normal
3926no option dontlog-normal
3927 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | yes | yes | no
3930 Arguments : none
3931
3932 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3933 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3934 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3935 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3936 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3937 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3938 logged.
3939
3940 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3941 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3942 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003944 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003945 logging.
3946
3947
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003948option dontlognull
3949no option dontlognull
3950 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3952 yes | yes | yes | no
3953 Arguments : none
3954
3955 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3956 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3957 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3958 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3959 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3960 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3961 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3962
3963 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3964 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3965 would not be logged.
3966
3967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003970 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003971
3972
3973option forceclose
3974no option forceclose
3975 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003977 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003978 Arguments : none
3979
3980 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3981 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3982 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3983 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3984 global session times in the logs.
3985
3986 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003987 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003988 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003989
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003990 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3991 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3992 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3993
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003994 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3995 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003996
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003997 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3998 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3999
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004000 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004001
4002
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004003option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004004 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4006 yes | yes | yes | yes
4007 Arguments :
4008 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4009 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004010 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004011 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004012
4013 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4014 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4015 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4016 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4017 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4018 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4019 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004020 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4021 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4022 possible that the client has already brought one.
4023
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004024 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004025 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004026 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4027 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004028 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4029 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004030
4031 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4032 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4033 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4034 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4035 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4036 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4037 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4038
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004039 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4040 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4041 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4042 are under the control of the end-user.
4043
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004044 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004045 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4046 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004047 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4048 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4049 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004050
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004051 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004052 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4053 frontend www
4054 mode http
4055 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4056
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004057 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4058 backend www
4059 mode http
4060 option forwardfor header X-Client
4061
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004062 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004063 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004064
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004065
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004066option http-keep-alive
4067no option http-keep-alive
4068 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4070 yes | yes | yes | yes
4071 Arguments : none
4072
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004073 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4074 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4075 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4076 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4077 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4078 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4079 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4080
4081 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4082 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004083 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4084 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4085 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4086 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4087 situations where this option may be useful :
4088
4089 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4090 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4091
4092 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4093 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4094
4095 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4096 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4097 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4098 request.
4099
4100 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4101 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004102 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4103 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4104 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004105
4106 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4107 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4108
4109 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4110 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4111 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4112 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4113 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4114 not set.
4115
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004116 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4117 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004118 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004119 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004120
4121 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004122 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4123 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004124
4125
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004126option http-no-delay
4127no option http-no-delay
4128 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4130 yes | yes | yes | yes
4131 Arguments : none
4132
4133 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4134 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4135 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4136 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4137 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4138 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4139 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4140 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4141 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4142 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4143 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4144 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4145 affected.
4146
4147 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4148 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4149 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4150 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4151 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4152 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4153 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4154 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4155 latency environments.
4156
4157
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004158option http-pretend-keepalive
4159no option http-pretend-keepalive
4160 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4162 yes | yes | yes | yes
4163 Arguments : none
4164
4165 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4166 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4167 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4168 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4169 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4170 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4171 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4172 consider the response complete.
4173
4174 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4175 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4176 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4177 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4178 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4179 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4180
4181 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4182 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4183 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4184 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4185 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4186 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4187 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4188
4189 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4190 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004191 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004192 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4193 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004194
4195 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4196 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4197
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004198 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4199 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004200
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004201
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004202option http-server-close
4203no option http-server-close
4204 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4206 yes | yes | yes | yes
4207 Arguments : none
4208
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004209 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4210 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4211 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4212 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4213 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4214 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4215 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4216 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4217 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4218 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4219 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4220 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4221 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4222 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4223 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4224 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004225
4226 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4227 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4228 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4229 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004230 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4231 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004232
4233 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4234 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004235 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4236 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004237 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4238 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004239
4240 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4241 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4242
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004243 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004244 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4245 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004246
4247
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004248option http-tunnel
4249no option http-tunnel
4250 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 yes | yes | yes | yes
4253 Arguments : none
4254
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004255 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4256 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4257 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4258 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4259 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4260 "option http-tunnel".
4261
4262 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004263 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004264 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4265 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4266 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4267 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4268 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4269 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4270 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004271
4272 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4273 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4274
4275 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4276 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4277 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4278
4279
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004280option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004281no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004282 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4284 yes | yes | yes | no
4285 Arguments : none
4286
4287 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4288 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4289 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4290 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4291 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4292 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4293 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4294
4295 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4296 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4297 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4298 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4299 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4300 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4301 request along its whole life.
4302
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004303 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4304 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4305 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4306 front of an existing proxy.
4307
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004308 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4309
4310 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4311 http-server-close".
4312
4313
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004314option httpchk
4315option httpchk <uri>
4316option httpchk <method> <uri>
4317option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4318 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4320 yes | no | yes | yes
4321 Arguments :
4322 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4323 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4324 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4325 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4326 ones.
4327
4328 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4329 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4330 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4331
4332 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4333 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4334 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4335 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4336 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4337
4338 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4339 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4340 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4341 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4342 the lack of any response.
4343
4344 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4345
4346 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4347 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4348 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4349
4350 Examples :
4351 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4352 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4353 backend https_relay
4354 mode tcp
4355 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4356 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4357
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004358 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4359 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4360 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004361
4362
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004363option httpclose
4364no option httpclose
4365 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 yes | yes | yes | yes
4368 Arguments : none
4369
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004370 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4371 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4372 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4373 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004374 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004375 "option http-tunnel".
4376
4377 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4378 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4379 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4380 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4381 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4382 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4383 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4384 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004385
4386 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004387 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004388 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4389 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4390 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4391 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4392 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004393
4394 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4395 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004396 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4397 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004398 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4399 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004400
4401 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4402 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4403
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004404 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4405 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004406
4407
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004408option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004409 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004412 Arguments :
4413 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4414 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4415 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4416 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4417 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004418
4419 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4420 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4421 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4422 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4423 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4424 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4425 ports.
4426
4427 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4428
PiBa-NL211c2e92014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004429 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4430 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004432 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004433
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004434
4435option http_proxy
4436no option http_proxy
4437 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4439 yes | yes | yes | yes
4440 Arguments : none
4441
4442 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4443 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4444 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4445 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4446 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4447
4448 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4449 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4450 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4451 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004452 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004453 be analyzed.
4454
4455 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4456 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4457
4458 Example :
4459 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4460 backend direct_forward
4461 option httpclose
4462 option http_proxy
4463
4464 See also : "option httpclose"
4465
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004466
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004467option independent-streams
4468no option independent-streams
4469 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4471 yes | yes | yes | yes
4472 Arguments : none
4473
4474 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4475 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4476 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4477 receive data or not.
4478
4479 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4480 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4481 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4482 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4483 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4484 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4485 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4486 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4487 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4488 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4489 socket buffers.
4490
4491 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4492 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4493 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4494 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4495 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4496
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004497 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004498 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4499 deprecated.
4500
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004501 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004502
4503
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004504option ldap-check
4505 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4507 yes | no | yes | yes
4508 Arguments : none
4509
4510 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4511 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4512 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4513 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4514
4515 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4516 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4517
4518 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4519 configure it.
4520
4521 Example :
4522 option ldap-check
4523
4524 See also : "option httpchk"
4525
4526
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004527option log-health-checks
4528no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004529 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4531 yes | no | yes | yes
4532 Arguments : none
4533
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004534 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4535 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4536 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004537
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004538 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4539 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4540 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4541 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4542 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4543
4544 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4545 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004546
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004547 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4548 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4549 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004550
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004551
4552option log-separate-errors
4553no option log-separate-errors
4554 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4556 yes | yes | yes | no
4557 Arguments : none
4558
4559 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4560 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4561 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4562 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4563 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4564 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4565 provides very important information.
4566
4567 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4568 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4569 error logs.
4570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004571 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004572 logging.
4573
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004574
4575option logasap
4576no option logasap
4577 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 yes | yes | yes | no
4580 Arguments : none
4581
4582 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4583 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4584 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4585 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4586 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4587 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4588 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004589 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004590 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4591 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4592
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004593 Examples :
4594 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4595 mode http
4596 option httplog
4597 option logasap
4598 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4599
4600 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4601 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4602 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4603 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004605 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004606 logging.
4607
4608
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004609option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004610 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4612 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004613 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004614 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4615 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004616 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004617
4618 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4619 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4620 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4621 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4622 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4623 in the MySQL table, like this :
4624
4625 USE mysql;
4626 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4627 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4628
4629 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4630 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4631 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4632 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4633 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4634 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4635 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4636 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4637 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4638
4639 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4640 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004641
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004642 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004643
4644 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4645 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4646 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4647 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4648 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4649 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4650
4651 See also: "option httpchk"
4652
4653
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004654option nolinger
4655no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004656 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4658 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004659 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004660
4661 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4662 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4663 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4664 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4665 connections.
4666
4667 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4668 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4669 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4670 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4671 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4672 this too.
4673
4674 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4675 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4676 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4677
4678 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4679 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4680 for servers.
4681
4682 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4683 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4684
4685
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004686option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4687 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4689 yes | yes | yes | yes
4690 Arguments :
4691 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4692 matching <network>
4693 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4694 header name.
4695
4696 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4697 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4698 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4699 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4700 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4701 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4702 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4703 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4704 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4705 possible that the client has already brought one.
4706
4707 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4708 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4709 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4710 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4711 header and requires different one.
4712
4713 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4714 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4715 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4716 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4717 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4718 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4719 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4720
4721 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4722 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4723 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4724 both are defined.
4725
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004726 Examples :
4727 # Original Destination address
4728 frontend www
4729 mode http
4730 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4731
4732 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4733 backend www
4734 mode http
4735 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4736
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004737 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4738 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004739
4740
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004741option persist
4742no option persist
4743 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004746 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004747
4748 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4749 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4750 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4751 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4752 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4753 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4754 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4755 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4756 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4757 redirected to another valid server.
4758
4759 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4760 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4761
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004762 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004763
4764
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004765option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4766 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4768 yes | no | yes | yes
4769 Arguments :
4770 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4771 PostgreSQL server.
4772
4773 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4774 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4775 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4776 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4777
4778 See also: "option httpchk"
4779
4780
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004781option prefer-last-server
4782no option prefer-last-server
4783 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | no | yes | yes
4786 Arguments : none
4787
4788 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4789 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4790 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4791 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4792 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4793 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4794 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4795 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4796 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004797 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4798 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4799 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4800 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4801 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4802 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4803 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004804
4805 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4806 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4807
4808 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4809
4810
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004811option redispatch
4812no option redispatch
4813 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4814 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4815 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004816 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004817
4818 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4819 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4820 be able to access the service anymore.
4821
4822 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4823 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4824
4825 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4826 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4827 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004829 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4830 "redisp" keywords.
4831
4832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4834
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004835 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004836
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004837
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004838option redis-check
4839 Use redis health checks for server testing
4840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4841 yes | no | yes | yes
4842 Arguments : none
4843
4844 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4845 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4846 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4847 find the "+PONG" response message.
4848
4849 Example :
4850 option redis-check
4851
4852 See also : "option httpchk"
4853
4854
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004855option smtpchk
4856option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4857 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004860 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004861 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4862 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4863 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4864
4865 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4866 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4867 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4868
4869 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4870 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4871 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4872 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4873 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4874 dead server.
4875
4876 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4877 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4878 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4879 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4880
4881 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4882 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4883 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4884 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4885 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4886
4887 Example :
4888 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4889
4890 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004893option socket-stats
4894no option socket-stats
4895
4896 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4898 yes | yes | yes | no
4899
4900 Arguments : none
4901
4902
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004903option splice-auto
4904no option splice-auto
4905 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4907 yes | yes | yes | yes
4908 Arguments : none
4909
4910 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4911 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4912 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4913 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004914 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004915 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4916 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4917 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4918 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4919
4920 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4921 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4922 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4923 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4924 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4925 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4926 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4927 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4928 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4929 keyword.
4930
4931 Example :
4932 option splice-auto
4933
4934 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4935 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4936
4937 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4938 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4939
4940
4941option splice-request
4942no option splice-request
4943 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4945 yes | yes | yes | yes
4946 Arguments : none
4947
4948 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004949 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004950 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4951 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4952 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4953 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4954
4955 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4956
4957 Example :
4958 option splice-request
4959
4960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4962
4963 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4964 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4965
4966
4967option splice-response
4968no option splice-response
4969 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 yes | yes | yes | yes
4972 Arguments : none
4973
4974 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004975 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004976 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4977 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4978 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4979 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4980
4981 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4982
4983 Example :
4984 option splice-response
4985
4986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4988
4989 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4990 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4991
4992
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004993option srvtcpka
4994no option srvtcpka
4995 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 yes | no | yes | yes
4998 Arguments : none
4999
5000 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5001 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5002 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5003 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5004
5005 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5006 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5007 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5008 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5009
5010 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5011 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5012 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5013 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5014 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5015
5016 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5017
5018 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5019 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5020 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5021
5022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5024
5025 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5026
5027
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005028option ssl-hello-chk
5029 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5031 yes | no | yes | yes
5032 Arguments : none
5033
5034 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5035 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5036 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5037 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5038 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5039 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5040 hello message.
5041
5042 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5043 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5044 messages, which is appreciable.
5045
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005046 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5047 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5048 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005049
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005050 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5051
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005052
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005053option tcp-check
5054 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5056 yes | no | yes | yes
5057
5058 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5059 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5060
5061 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5062 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5063 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5064
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005065 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005066 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5067 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5068 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5069 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5070 only.
5071
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005072 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005073 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5074 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5075 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5076 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5077
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005078 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005079 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5080 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005081 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005082 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5083 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5084 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5085 the respective protocols.
5086 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5087 analysed.
5088
5089 Examples :
5090 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5091 option tcp-check
5092 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5093
5094 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5095 option tcp-check
5096 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5097
5098 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5099 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005100 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005101 option tcp-check
5102 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5103 tcp-check expect +PONG
5104 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5105 tcp-check expect string role:master
5106 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5107 tcp-check expect string +OK
5108
5109 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5110 (send many headers before analyzing)
5111 option tcp-check
5112 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5113 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5114 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5115 tcp-check send \r\n
5116 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5117
5118
5119 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5120
5121
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005122option tcp-smart-accept
5123no option tcp-smart-accept
5124 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5126 yes | yes | yes | no
5127 Arguments : none
5128
5129 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5130 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5131 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5132 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5133 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5134 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5135
5136 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5137 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5138 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5139 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5140
5141 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5142 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5143 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5144 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5145
5146 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5147 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5148 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5149
5150 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5151 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5152 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5153
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005154 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5155
5156
5157option tcp-smart-connect
5158no option tcp-smart-connect
5159 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5161 yes | no | yes | yes
5162 Arguments : none
5163
5164 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5165 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5166 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5167 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5168 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5169
5170 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5171 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5172 complex.
5173
5174 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5175 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5176 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5177
5178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5180
5181 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5182
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005183
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005184option tcpka
5185 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 yes | yes | yes | yes
5188 Arguments : none
5189
5190 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5191 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5192 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5193 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5194
5195 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5196 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5197 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5198 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5199
5200 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5201 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5202 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5203 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5204 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5205
5206 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5207
5208 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5209 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5210 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5211 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5212 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5213 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5214 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5215 backends.
5216
5217 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5218
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005219
5220option tcplog
5221 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5223 yes | yes | yes | yes
5224 Arguments : none
5225
5226 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5227 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5228 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5229 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5230 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5231 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5232 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5233 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5234
5235 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005237 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005238
5239
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005240option transparent
5241no option transparent
5242 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005244 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005245 Arguments : none
5246
5247 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5248 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5249 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5250 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5251 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5252 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5253 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5254 appropriate server.
5255
5256 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5257 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5258
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005259 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005260 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005261
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005262
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005263persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005264persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005265 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5267 yes | no | yes | yes
5268 Arguments :
5269 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005270 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5271 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005272
5273 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5274 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5275 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5276 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5277 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5278 forwarded to this server.
5279
5280 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5281 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5282 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005283 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005284 a single "listen" section.
5285
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005286 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5287 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5288 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5289
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005290 Example :
5291 listen tse-farm
5292 bind :3389
5293 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5294 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5295 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5296 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5297 persist rdp-cookie
5298 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005299 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005300 balance rdp-cookie
5301 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5302 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5303
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005304 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5305 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005306
5307
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005308rate-limit sessions <rate>
5309 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5311 yes | yes | yes | no
5312 Arguments :
5313 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5314 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5315
5316 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5317 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5318 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5319 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5320 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5321 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5322
5323 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5324 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5325 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5326 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5327
5328 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5329 listen smtp
5330 mode tcp
5331 bind :25
5332 rate-limit sessions 10
5333 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5334
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005335 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5336 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5337 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005338
5339 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5340
5341
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005342redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5343redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5344redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005345 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5347 no | yes | yes | yes
5348
5349 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005350 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005351
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005352 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005353 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005354 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5355 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5356 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005357
5358 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5359 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5360 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5361 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5362 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005363 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5364 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5365 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5366 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005367
5368 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5369 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5370 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5371 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5372 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5373 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005374 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005375 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005376 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5377 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5378 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005379
5380 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005381 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5382 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5383 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5384 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5385 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5386 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5387 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5388 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005389
5390 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5391 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5392
5393 - "drop-query"
5394 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5395 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5396 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5397 with a location-type redirect.
5398
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005399 - "append-slash"
5400 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5401 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5402 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5403 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5404
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005405 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5406 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5407 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5408 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5409 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5410 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5411 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5412
5413 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5414 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5415 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5416 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5417 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5418 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5419 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005420
5421 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5422 acl clear dst_port 80
5423 acl secure dst_port 8080
5424 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005425 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005426 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005427 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5428
5429 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005430 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5431 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5432 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005433 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005434
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005435 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5436 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5437 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5438
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005439 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005440 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005441
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005442 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5443 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5444 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005446 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005447
5448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005449redisp (deprecated)
5450redispatch (deprecated)
5451 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5452 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5453 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005454 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005455
5456 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5457 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5458 be able to access the service anymore.
5459
5460 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5461 redistribute them to a working server.
5462
5463 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5464 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5465 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005467 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5468 "option redispatch" instead.
5469
5470 See also : "option redispatch"
5471
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005472
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005473reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005474 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5476 no | yes | yes | yes
5477 Arguments :
5478 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5479 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005480 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005481
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005482 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5483 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5484
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005485 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5486 the last header of an HTTP request.
5487
5488 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5489 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5490 responses.
5491
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005492 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5493 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5494 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5495
5496 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5497 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005498
5499
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005500reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5501reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005502 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5504 no | yes | yes | yes
5505 Arguments :
5506 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5507 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5508 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5509 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5510 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5511 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5512 ignores case.
5513
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005514 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5515 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5516
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005517 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5518 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5519 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5520 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005521 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005522
5523 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5524 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5525
5526 Example :
5527 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5528 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5529 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5530
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005531 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5532 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005533
5534
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005535reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5536reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005537 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 no | yes | yes | yes
5540 Arguments :
5541 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5542 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5543 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5544 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5545 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5546 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5547
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005548 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5549 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5550
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005551 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5552 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5553 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5554 next servers.
5555
5556 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5557 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5558 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5559
5560 Example :
5561 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5562 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5563 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5564
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005565 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5566 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005567
5568
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005569reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5570reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005571 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5573 no | yes | yes | yes
5574 Arguments :
5575 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5576 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5577 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5578 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5579 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5580 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5581 case.
5582
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005583 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5584 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5585
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005586 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5587 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5588 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5589 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005590 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005591
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005592 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005593 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005594 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005595
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005596 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5597 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5598
5599 Example :
5600 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5601 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5602 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5603
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005604 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5605 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005606
5607
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005608reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5609reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005610 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5612 no | yes | yes | yes
5613 Arguments :
5614 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5615 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5616 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5617 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5618 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5619 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5620 case.
5621
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005622 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5623 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5624
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005625 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5626 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5627 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5628 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5629
5630 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5631 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5632
5633 Example :
5634 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5635 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5636 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5637 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5638
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005639 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5640 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005641
5642
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005643reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5644reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005645 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5647 no | yes | yes | yes
5648 Arguments :
5649 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5650 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5651 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5652 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5653 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5654 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5655
5656 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5657 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5658 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5659 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005660 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005661
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005662 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5663 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5664
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005665 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5666 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5667 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5668
5669 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5670 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5671 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5672 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5673 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5674
5675 Example :
5676 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005677 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005678 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5679 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5680
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005681 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5682 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005683
5684
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005685reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5686reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005687 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5689 no | yes | yes | yes
5690 Arguments :
5691 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5692 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5693 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5694 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5695 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5696 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5697 ignores case.
5698
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005699 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5700 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5701
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005702 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5703 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005704 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5705 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5706 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005707 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5708 not set.
5709
5710 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5711 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5712 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5713 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5714 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5715
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005716 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005717 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5718 # block all others.
5719 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5720 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5721
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005722 # block bad guys
5723 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5724 reqitarpit . if badguys
5725
5726 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5727 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005728
5729
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005730retries <value>
5731 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5732 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5733 yes | no | yes | yes
5734 Arguments :
5735 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5736 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5737 default value is 3.
5738
5739 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5740 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5741 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5742
5743 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5744 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5745
5746 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5747 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5748
5749 See also : "option redispatch"
5750
5751
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005752rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005753 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5755 no | yes | yes | yes
5756 Arguments :
5757 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5758 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005759 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005760
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005761 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5762 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5763
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005764 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5765 the last header of an HTTP response.
5766
5767 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5768 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5769 responses.
5770
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005771 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5772 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005773
5774
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005775rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5776rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005777 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 no | yes | yes | yes
5780 Arguments :
5781 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5782 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5783 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5784 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5785 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5786 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5787 ignores case.
5788
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005789 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5790 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5791
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005792 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5793 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005794 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005795 client.
5796
5797 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5798 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5799 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5800
5801 Example :
5802 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005803 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005804
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005805 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5806 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005807
5808
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005809rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5810rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005811 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5813 no | yes | yes | yes
5814 Arguments :
5815 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5816 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5817 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5818 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5819 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5820 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5821 ignores case.
5822
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005823 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5824 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5825
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005826 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5827 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5828 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5829 case-sensitive.
5830
5831 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005832 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5833 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5834 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005835
5836 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5837 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5838
5839 Example :
5840 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5841 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5842
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005843 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5844 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005845
5846
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005847rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5848rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005849 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 no | yes | yes | yes
5852 Arguments :
5853 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5854 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5855 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5856 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5857 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5858 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5859 ignores case.
5860
5861 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5862 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5863 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5864 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005865 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005866
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005867 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5868 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5869
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005870 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5871 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5872 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5873
5874 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5875 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5876 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5877 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5878 are not case-sensitive.
5879
5880 Example :
5881 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5882 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5883
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005884 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5885 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005886
5887
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005888server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005889 Declare a server in a backend
5890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5891 no | no | yes | yes
5892 Arguments :
5893 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005894 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005895 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005896
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005897 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5898 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5899 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5900 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005901 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5902 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5903 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5904 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5905 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005906 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5907 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5908 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5909 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5910 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5911 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5912 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005913 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005914 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5915 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5916 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5917 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005919 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005920 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5921 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5922 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5923 adding this value to the client's port.
5924
5925 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5926 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005927 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005928
5929 Examples :
5930 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5931 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005932 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005933 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5934 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5935 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005936
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005937 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5938 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005939
5940
5941source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005942source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005943source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005944 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5946 yes | no | yes | yes
5947 Arguments :
5948 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5949 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005950
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005951 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005952 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5953 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5954 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5955 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5956 supported prefixes are :
5957 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5958 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5959 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005960 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005961 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5962 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5963 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5964 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005965
5966 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5967 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005968 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5969 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5970 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005971
5972 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5973 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5974 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5975 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5976 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5977 <addr>.
5978
5979 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5980 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5981 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5982 port.
5983
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005984 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5985 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5986 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5987 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005988 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005989 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5990 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5991 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5992 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5993 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5994 HTTP header.
5995
5996 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5997 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005998 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005999 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6000 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6001 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6002 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6003 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6004 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6005 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6006
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006007 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6008 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6009 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6010 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6011 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6012 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6013
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006014 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6015 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6016 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6017 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6018
6019 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6020 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6021 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6022 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6023 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6024 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6025
6026 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6027 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6028 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6029 there are two methods :
6030
6031 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6032 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6033 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6034 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6035 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6036 of the client ranges may be used.
6037
6038 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6039 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6040 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6041 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6042 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6043 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6044 same session.
6045
6046 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6047 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6048 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6049 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6050 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6051 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6052
6053 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6054 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6055 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006056 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006057
6058 Examples :
6059 backend private
6060 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6061 source 192.168.1.200
6062
6063 backend transparent_ssl1
6064 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6065 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6066
6067 backend transparent_ssl2
6068 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6069 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6070 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6071
6072 backend transparent_ssl3
6073 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6074 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6075 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6076
6077 backend transparent_smtp
6078 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6079 # with Tproxy version 4.
6080 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6081
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006082 backend transparent_http
6083 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6084 # proxy.
6085 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006087 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006088 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006090
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006091srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6092 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6094 yes | no | yes | yes
6095 Arguments :
6096 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6097 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6098 as explained at the top of this document.
6099
6100 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6101 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6102 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6103 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6104 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6105 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6106 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6107
6108 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6109 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6110 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6111 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6112 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006113 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006114 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006115 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006116
6117 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6118 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6119 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6120 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6121 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6122 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6123
6124 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6125 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6126
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006127 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6128 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006129
6130
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006131stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6132 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006134 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006135
6136 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6137 matched.
6138
6139 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6140 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6141
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006142 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6143 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6144 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6145
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006146 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6147 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6148 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6149 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006150
6151 Example :
6152 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6153 backend stats_localhost
6154 stats enable
6155 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6156
6157 Example :
6158 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6159 backend stats_auth
6160 stats enable
6161 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6162 stats admin if TRUE
6163
6164 Example :
6165 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6166 userlist stats-auth
6167 group admin users admin
6168 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6169 group readonly users haproxy
6170 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6171
6172 backend stats_auth
6173 stats enable
6174 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6175 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6176 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6177 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6178
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006179 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6180 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6181 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006182
6183
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006184stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6185 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006187 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006188 Arguments :
6189 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6190
6191 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6192
6193 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6194 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6195 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6196 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6197 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6198 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6199
6200 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6201 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6202 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006203 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006204
6205 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6206 report using "stats scope".
6207
6208 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6209 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6210 unobvious parameters.
6211
6212 Example :
6213 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6214 backend public_www
6215 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6216 stats enable
6217 stats hide-version
6218 stats scope .
6219 stats uri /admin?stats
6220 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6221 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6222 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6223
6224 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6225 backend private_monitoring
6226 stats enable
6227 stats uri /admin?stats
6228 stats refresh 5s
6229
6230 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6231
6232
6233stats enable
6234 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006236 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006237 Arguments : none
6238
6239 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6240 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6241 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6242 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6243 - stats auth : no authentication
6244 - stats scope : no restriction
6245
6246 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6247 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6248 unobvious parameters.
6249
6250 Example :
6251 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6252 backend public_www
6253 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6254 stats enable
6255 stats hide-version
6256 stats scope .
6257 stats uri /admin?stats
6258 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6259 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6260 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6261
6262 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6263 backend private_monitoring
6264 stats enable
6265 stats uri /admin?stats
6266 stats refresh 5s
6267
6268 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6269
6270
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006271stats hide-version
6272 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006274 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006275 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006276
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006277 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6278 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6279 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6280 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6281 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6282 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006284 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6285 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6286 unobvious parameters.
6287
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006288 Example :
6289 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6290 backend public_www
6291 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006292 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006293 stats hide-version
6294 stats scope .
6295 stats uri /admin?stats
6296 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6297 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6298 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006299
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006300 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6301 backend private_monitoring
6302 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006303 stats uri /admin?stats
6304 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006305
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006306 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006307
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006308
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006309stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6310 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6311 Access control for statistics
6312
6313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6314 no | no | yes | yes
6315
6316 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6317 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6318 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6319 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6320 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6321 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6322
6323 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6324 instance.
6325
6326 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6327 about ACL usage.
6328
6329
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006330stats realm <realm>
6331 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006333 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006334 Arguments :
6335 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6336 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6337 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6338
6339 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6340 using a backslash ('\').
6341
6342 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6343 only related to authentication.
6344
6345 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6346 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6347 unobvious parameters.
6348
6349 Example :
6350 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6351 backend public_www
6352 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6353 stats enable
6354 stats hide-version
6355 stats scope .
6356 stats uri /admin?stats
6357 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6358 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6359 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6360
6361 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6362 backend private_monitoring
6363 stats enable
6364 stats uri /admin?stats
6365 stats refresh 5s
6366
6367 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6368
6369
6370stats refresh <delay>
6371 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006373 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006374 Arguments :
6375 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6376 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6377 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6378 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6379 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6380 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6381
6382 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6383 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6384 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6385 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6386
6387 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6388 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6389 unobvious parameters.
6390
6391 Example :
6392 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6393 backend public_www
6394 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6395 stats enable
6396 stats hide-version
6397 stats scope .
6398 stats uri /admin?stats
6399 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6400 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6401 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6402
6403 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6404 backend private_monitoring
6405 stats enable
6406 stats uri /admin?stats
6407 stats refresh 5s
6408
6409 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6410
6411
6412stats scope { <name> | "." }
6413 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006415 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006416 Arguments :
6417 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6418 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6419 section in which the statement appears.
6420
6421 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6422 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6423 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6424 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6425 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6426 exists.
6427
6428 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6429 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6430 unobvious parameters.
6431
6432 Example :
6433 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6434 backend public_www
6435 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6436 stats enable
6437 stats hide-version
6438 stats scope .
6439 stats uri /admin?stats
6440 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6441 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6442 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6443
6444 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6445 backend private_monitoring
6446 stats enable
6447 stats uri /admin?stats
6448 stats refresh 5s
6449
6450 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6451
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006452
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006453stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006454 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006456 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006457
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006458 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006459 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6460
6461 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6462 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6463
6464 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6465 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006466 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006467
6468 Example :
6469 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6470 backend private_monitoring
6471 stats enable
6472 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6473 stats uri /admin?stats
6474 stats refresh 5s
6475
6476 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6477 global section.
6478
6479
6480stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006481 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | yes | yes | yes
6484 Arguments : none
6485
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006486 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006487 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6488 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6489 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6490 - IP (socket, server)
6491 - cookie (backend, server)
6492
6493 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6494 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006495 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006496
6497 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6498
6499
6500stats show-node [ <name> ]
6501 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006503 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006504 Arguments:
6505 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6506 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6507
6508 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6509 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006510 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006511
6512 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6513 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6514 unobvious parameters.
6515
6516 Example:
6517 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6518 backend private_monitoring
6519 stats enable
6520 stats show-node Europe-1
6521 stats uri /admin?stats
6522 stats refresh 5s
6523
6524 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6525 section.
6526
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006527
6528stats uri <prefix>
6529 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006531 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006532 Arguments :
6533 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6534 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6535 query string.
6536
6537 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6538 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6539 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6540 possible to reach it in the application.
6541
6542 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006543 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006544 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6545 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6546 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6547 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6548
6549 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6550 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6551 an address or a port to statistics only.
6552
6553 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6554 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6555 unobvious parameters.
6556
6557 Example :
6558 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6559 backend public_www
6560 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6561 stats enable
6562 stats hide-version
6563 stats scope .
6564 stats uri /admin?stats
6565 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6566 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6567 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6568
6569 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6570 backend private_monitoring
6571 stats enable
6572 stats uri /admin?stats
6573 stats refresh 5s
6574
6575 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6576
6577
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006578stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6579 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006581 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006582
6583 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006584 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006585 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6586 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6587 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6588
6589 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6590 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6591 the "stick-table" statement.
6592
6593 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6594 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6595 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6596 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6597 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6598
6599 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6600 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6601 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6602 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6603 transformation rules.
6604
6605 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6606 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6607 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6608 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6609 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6610 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6611 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6612
6613 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6614 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6615 ACL based conditions.
6616
6617 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6618 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6619 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6620 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6621
6622 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6623 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6624 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6625 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6626
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006627 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6628 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6629 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6630
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006631 Example :
6632 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6633 # last 30 minutes
6634 backend pop
6635 mode tcp
6636 balance roundrobin
6637 stick store-request src
6638 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6639 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6640 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6641
6642 backend smtp
6643 mode tcp
6644 balance roundrobin
6645 stick match src table pop
6646 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6647 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6648
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006649 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006650 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006651
6652
6653stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6654 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6656 no | no | yes | yes
6657
6658 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6659 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6660 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6661 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6662
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006663 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6664 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6665 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6666
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006667 Examples :
6668 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006669 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006670
6671 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6672 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6673 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6674
6675
6676 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6677 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6678 backend http
6679 mode http
6680 balance roundrobin
6681 stick on src table https
6682 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6683 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6684 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6685
6686 backend https
6687 mode tcp
6688 balance roundrobin
6689 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6690 stick on src
6691 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6692 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6693
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006694 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006695
6696
6697stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6698 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6700 no | no | yes | yes
6701
6702 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006703 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006704 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6705 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6706 server is selected.
6707
6708 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6709 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6710 the "stick-table" statement.
6711
6712 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6713 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6714 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6715 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6716 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6717 address.
6718
6719 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6720 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6721 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6722 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6723 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6724 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6725 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6726 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6727 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6728 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6729
6730 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6731 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6732 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6733 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6734 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6735 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6736 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6737
6738 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6739 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6740 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6741 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6742
6743 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6744 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6745 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6746 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6747 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6748 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006749 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6750 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6751 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6752 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6753 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6754 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006755
6756 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6757 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6758 the request.
6759
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006760 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6761 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6762 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6763
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006764 Example :
6765 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6766 # last 30 minutes
6767 backend pop
6768 mode tcp
6769 balance roundrobin
6770 stick store-request src
6771 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6772 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6773 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6774
6775 backend smtp
6776 mode tcp
6777 balance roundrobin
6778 stick match src table pop
6779 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6780 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6781
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006782 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006783 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006784
6785
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006786stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006787 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6788 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006789 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006791 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006792
6793 Arguments :
6794 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6795 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6796 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6797 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6798
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006799 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6800 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6801 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6802 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6803
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006804 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6805 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6806 instance.
6807
6808 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6809 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6810 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6811 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6812 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6813 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006814 to 32 characters.
6815
6816 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6817 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6818 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006819 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006820 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6821 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006822
6823 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006824 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6825 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006826 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6827 increase.
6828
6829 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006830 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6831 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6832 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006833
6834 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6835 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6836 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6837 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6838 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6839 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6840 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6841 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6842 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6843 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6844 parameter (see below).
6845
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006846 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6847 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6848 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6849 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6850 soft restart.
6851
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006852 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6853
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006854 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6855 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6856 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6857 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6858 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006859 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006860 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6861 if not expiration delay is specified.
6862
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006863 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6864 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6865 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6866 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006867 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6868 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6869 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6870 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6871 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6872 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6873 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6874 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6875 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6876 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6877 types and their arguments.
6878
6879 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6880 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6881 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6882 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6883
6884 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6885 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6886 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6887 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6888
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006889 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6890 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6891 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6892 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6893 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6894 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6895
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006896 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6897 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6898 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6899 they were received.
6900
6901 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6902 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6903 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6904 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6905 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6906
6907 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6908 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6909 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6910 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6911 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6912
6913 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6914 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6915 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6916
6917 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6918 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6919 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6920 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6921 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6922
6923 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6924 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6925 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6926 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6927 the client side.
6928
6929 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6930 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6931 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6932 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6933 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6934 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6935 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6936
6937 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6938 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6939 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6940 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6941 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6942 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6943 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6944
6945 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6946 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6947 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6948 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6949 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6950 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6951
6952 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6953 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6954 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6955 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6956
6957 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6958 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6959 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6960 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6961 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6962 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6963 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6964 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6965 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6966 recommended for better fairness.
6967
6968 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6969 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6970 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6971 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6972
6973 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6974 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6975 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6976 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6977 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6978 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6979 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6980 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6981 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6982 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006983
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006984 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6985 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006986 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6987 reference it.
6988
6989 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6990 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6991 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6992 as an exclusive stickiness.
6993
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006994 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6995 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6996 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6997 something that can be ignored.
6998
6999 Example:
7000 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7001 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7002 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7003 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7004
7005 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007006 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007007
7008
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007009stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7010 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7012 no | no | yes | yes
7013
7014 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007015 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007016 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7017 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7018 server is selected.
7019
7020 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7021 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7022 the "stick-table" statement.
7023
7024 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7025 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7026 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7027 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7028
7029 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7030 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7031 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7032 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7033 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7034 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007035 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007036 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7037 rules.
7038
7039 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7040 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7041 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7042 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7043 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7044 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7045 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7046
7047 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7048 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7049 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7050 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7051
7052 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7053 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7054 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7055 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7056 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7057 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007058 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7059 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7060 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7061 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7062 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7063 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7064 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7065 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7066 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007067
7068 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7069
7070 Example :
7071 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7072 backend https
7073 mode tcp
7074 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007075 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007076 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007077
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007078 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7079 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7080
7081 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7082 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7083 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7084
7085 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7086 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007087
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007088 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7089 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7090 # at offset 44.
7091
7092 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7093 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7094
7095 # Learn on response if server hello.
7096 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007097
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007098 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7099 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7100
7101 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7102 extraction.
7103
7104
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007105tcp-check connect [params*]
7106 Opens a new connection
7107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7108 no | no | yes | yes
7109
7110 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7111 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7112 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7113
7114 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7115 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7116 of the sequence.
7117
7118 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7119 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7120 do.
7121
7122 Parameters :
7123 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7124 use the TCP connection.
7125
7126 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7127 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7128 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7129
7130 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7131
7132 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7133
7134 Examples:
7135 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7136 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7137 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7138 option tcp-check
7139 tcp-check connect
7140 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7141 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7142 tcp-check send \r\n
7143 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7144 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7145 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7146 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7147 tcp-check send \r\n
7148 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7149 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7150
7151 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7152 option tcp-check
7153 tcp-check connect port 110
7154 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7155 tcp-check connect port 143
7156 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7157 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7158
7159 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7160
7161
7162tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7163 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7164 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7165 no | no | yes | yes
7166
7167 Arguments :
7168 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7169 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7170 binary.
7171 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7172 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7173 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7174
7175 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7176 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7177 with the usual backslash ('\').
7178 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7179 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7180 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7181 used upper or lower case.
7182
7183
7184 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7185
7186 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7187 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7188 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7189 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7190 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7191 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7192 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7193 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7194
7195 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7196 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7197 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7198 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7199 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7200 expression.
7201
7202 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7203 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7204 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7205 this exact hexadecimal string.
7206 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7207
7208 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7209 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7210 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7211 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7212 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7213 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7214 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7215 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7216 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7217 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7218 the null character.
7219
7220 Examples :
7221 # perform a POP check
7222 option tcp-check
7223 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7224
7225 # perform an IMAP check
7226 option tcp-check
7227 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7228
7229 # look for the redis master server
7230 option tcp-check
7231 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7232 tcp-check expect +PONG
7233 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7234 tcp-check expect string role:master
7235 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7236 tcp-check expect string +OK
7237
7238
7239 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7240 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7241
7242
7243tcp-check send <data>
7244 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7246 no | no | yes | yes
7247
7248 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7249 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7250
7251 Examples :
7252 # look for the redis master server
7253 option tcp-check
7254 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7255 tcp-check expect string role:master
7256
7257 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7258 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7259
7260
7261tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7262 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7263 tcp health check
7264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7265 no | no | yes | yes
7266
7267 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7268 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7269 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7270 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7271 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7272 hexadecimal string.
7273 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7274
7275 Examples :
7276 # redis check in binary
7277 option tcp-check
7278 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7279 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7280
7281
7282 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7283 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7284
7285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007286tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7287 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7289 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007290 Arguments :
7291 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007292 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7293 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007294
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007295 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007296
7297 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7298 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007299 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7300 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7301 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7302 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7303 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7304 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007305
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007306 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7307 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7308 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7309 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007310
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007311 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007312 - accept :
7313 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7314 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7315 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007317 - reject :
7318 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7319 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7320 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7321 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7322 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7323 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7324 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7325 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7326 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7327 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7328 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7329 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007330
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007331 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7332 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7333 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7334 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7335 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7336 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7337 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7338 hosts.
7339
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007340 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7341 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7342 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7343 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7344 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7345 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7346 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7347 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7348 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7349 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7350 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7351
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007352 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007353 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7354 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7355 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007356 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7357 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007358 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007359 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7360 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7361 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7362 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7363 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007364
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007365 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007366 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007367 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007368 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7369 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7370 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7371 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007372
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007373 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7374 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7375 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7376 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007377
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007378 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7379 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7380 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7381 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7382 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007383 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7384 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7385 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7386 layer7 information is extracted.
7387
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007388 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7389 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7390 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7391 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7392 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007393
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007394 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7395 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7396 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007398 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7399 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7400 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007401
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007402 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007403 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007404 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007405
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007406 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7407 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7408 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007409
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007410 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007411 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7412 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007413
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007414 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7415
7416 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7417
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007418 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007420 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007421
7422
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007423tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7424 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007426 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007427 Arguments :
7428 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007429 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007430 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7431 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007432
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007433 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007434
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007435 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7436 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7437 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7438 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7439 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007440
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007441 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7442 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7443 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7444 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007445 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7446 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7447 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7448 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7449 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7450 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007451 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007452 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007453
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007454 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7455 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7456 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7457 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007458
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007459 Four types of actions are supported :
7460 - accept : the request is accepted
7461 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7462 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007463 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007464
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007465 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7466 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007467
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007468 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7469 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7470 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7471 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7472 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7473 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007475 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007476 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7477 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007479 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007480 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7481 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7482 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7483 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007484 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7485 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7486 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007487
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007488 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007489 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7490 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7491 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007492
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007493 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007494 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7495 # and reject everything else.
7496 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7497 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007498 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007499 tcp-request content reject
7500
7501 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007502 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7503 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7504 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007505 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007506
7507 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7508 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7509 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007510 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007511 tcp-request content reject
7512
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007513 Example:
7514 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7515 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007516 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007517
7518 Example:
7519 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7520 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007521 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007522
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007523 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7524 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7525
7526 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007527 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007528 # protecting all our sites
7529 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007530 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7531 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007532 ...
7533 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7534
7535 backend http_dynamic
7536 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007537 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007538 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007539 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7540 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7541 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007542 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007544 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007545
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007546 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007547
7548
7549tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7550 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007552 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007553 Arguments :
7554 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7555 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7556 as explained at the top of this document.
7557
7558 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7559 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7560 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7561 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7562 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7563
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007564 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7565 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7566 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7567 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7568
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007569 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7570 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007571 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007572 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007573 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7574 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7575 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7576 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007577
7578 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7579 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7580 it pass through unaffected.
7581
7582 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7583 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7584 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007585 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007586 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7587 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007588 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7589 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7590 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007591
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007592 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007593 "timeout client".
7594
7595
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007596tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7597 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 no | no | yes | yes
7600 Arguments :
7601 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007602 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007603
7604 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7605
7606 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7607 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7608 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007609 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7610 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007611
7612 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7613
7614 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7615 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7616 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7617 inserted.
7618
7619 Two types of actions are supported :
7620 - accept :
7621 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7622 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7623 the rules evaluation.
7624
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007625 - close :
7626 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7627 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7628 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7629 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7630 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7631 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007632 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007633 protocols.
7634
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007635 - reject :
7636 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7637 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007638 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007639
7640 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7641 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7642 for changing the default action to a reject.
7643
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007644 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7645 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7646 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7647 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007648 period.
7649
7650 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7651
7652 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7653
7654
7655tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7656 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7658 no | no | yes | yes
7659 Arguments :
7660 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7661 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7662 as explained at the top of this document.
7663
7664 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7665
7666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007667timeout check <timeout>
7668 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7669 established.
7670
7671 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7672 yes | no | yes | yes
7673 Arguments:
7674 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7675 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7676 as explained at the top of this document.
7677
7678 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7679 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7680 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7681 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007682 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7683 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7684 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007685
7686 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7687 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7688
7689 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7690 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007691 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007692
7693 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7694 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7695 forget about it.
7696
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007697 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7698 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007699
7700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007701timeout client <timeout>
7702timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7703 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7705 yes | yes | yes | no
7706 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007707 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007708 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7709 as explained at the top of this document.
7710
7711 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7712 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7713 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7714 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7715 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7716 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7717 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7718 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007719 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007720 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007721 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7722 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007723 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7724 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007725
7726 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7727 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7728 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7729 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7730 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7731 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7732
7733 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7734 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7735 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7736
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007737 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007738
7739
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007740timeout client-fin <timeout>
7741 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7743 yes | yes | yes | no
7744 Arguments :
7745 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7746 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7747 as explained at the top of this document.
7748
7749 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7750 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7751 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7752 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7753 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7754 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7755 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7756 down in one direction.
7757
7758 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7759 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7760 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7761
7762 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7763
7764
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007765timeout connect <timeout>
7766timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7767 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7769 yes | no | yes | yes
7770 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007771 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007772 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7773 as explained at the top of this document.
7774
7775 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007776 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007777 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007778 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007779 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7780 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007781
7782 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7783 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7784 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7785 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7786 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7787 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7788
7789 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7790 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7791 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7792
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007793 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7794 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007795
7796
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007797timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7798 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7800 yes | yes | yes | yes
7801 Arguments :
7802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7804 as explained at the top of this document.
7805
7806 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7807 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7808 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7809 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7810 once the request has started to present itself.
7811
7812 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7813 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7814 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7815 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7816 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7817
7818 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7819 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7820 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7821 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7822
7823 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7824 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7825 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7826 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7827 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007828 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007829
7830 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7831 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7832 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7833 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7834
7835 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7836
7837
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007838timeout http-request <timeout>
7839 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007841 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007842 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007843 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007844 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7845 as explained at the top of this document.
7846
7847 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7848 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7849 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7850 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7851 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7852 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7853 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007854 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7855 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7856 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7857 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7858 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7859 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7860 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007861
7862 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7863 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007864 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7865 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007866
7867 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7868 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7869 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7870 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7871 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7872
7873 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007874 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7875 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7876 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007877
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007878 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007879
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007880
7881timeout queue <timeout>
7882 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7884 yes | no | yes | yes
7885 Arguments :
7886 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7887 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7888 as explained at the top of this document.
7889
7890 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7891 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7892 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7893 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7894 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7895
7896 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7897 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7898 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7899 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7900
7901 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7902
7903
7904timeout server <timeout>
7905timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7906 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7908 yes | no | yes | yes
7909 Arguments :
7910 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7911 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7912 as explained at the top of this document.
7913
7914 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7915 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7916 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7917 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7918 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7919 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7920 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7921
7922 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7923 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7924 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7925 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7926 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007927 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007928 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007929 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7930 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7931 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7932 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007933
7934 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7935 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7936 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7937 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7938 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7939 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7940
7941 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7942 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7943 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7944
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007945 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007946
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007947
7948timeout server-fin <timeout>
7949 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 yes | no | yes | yes
7952 Arguments :
7953 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7954 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7955 as explained at the top of this document.
7956
7957 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7958 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7959 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7960 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7961 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7962 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7963 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7964 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7965 situations, it should not be needed.
7966
7967 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7968 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7969 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7970
7971 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7972
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007973
7974timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007975 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7977 yes | yes | yes | yes
7978 Arguments :
7979 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7980 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7981 as explained at the top of this document.
7982
7983 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7984 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7985 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7986
7987 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7988 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7989 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7990 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007991 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007992
7993 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7994
7995
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007996timeout tunnel <timeout>
7997 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7999 yes | no | yes | yes
8000 Arguments :
8001 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8002 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8003 as explained at the top of this document.
8004
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008005 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008006 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8007 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8008 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8009 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8010 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8011 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8012 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8013 specified.
8014
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008015 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8016 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8017 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8018 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8019 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8020 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8021 state.
8022
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008023 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8024 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8025 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8026 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8027 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8028
8029 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8030 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8031 forget about it.
8032
8033 Example :
8034 defaults http
8035 option http-server-close
8036 timeout connect 5s
8037 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008038 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008039 timeout server 30s
8040 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8041
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008042 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008043
8044
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008045transparent (deprecated)
8046 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008048 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008049 Arguments : none
8050
8051 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8052 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8053 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8054 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8055 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8056 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8057 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8058 appropriate server.
8059
8060 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8061
8062 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8063 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8064
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008065 See also: "option transparent"
8066
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008067unique-id-format <string>
8068 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8070 yes | yes | yes | no
8071 Arguments :
8072 <string> is a log-format string.
8073
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008074 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8075 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8076 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8077 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008078
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008079 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8080 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8081 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8082 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8083 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8084 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8085 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8086 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008087
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008088 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8089 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008090
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008091 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008092
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008093 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008094
8095 will generate:
8096
8097 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8098
8099 See also: "unique-id-header"
8100
8101unique-id-header <name>
8102 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8104 yes | yes | yes | no
8105 Arguments :
8106 <name> is the name of the header.
8107
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008108 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8109 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008110
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008111 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008112
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008113 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008114 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8115
8116 will generate:
8117
8118 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8119
8120 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008121
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008122use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008123 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8125 no | yes | yes | no
8126 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008127 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8128 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008129
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008130 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8131 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008132
8133 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8134 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8135 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008136 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8137 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8138 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8139 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008140
8141 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8142 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8143 assign the backend.
8144
8145 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8146 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8147 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8148 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8149 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8150 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8151
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008152 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008153 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008154 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8155 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8156 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8157
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008158 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8159 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8160 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8161 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8162 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8163 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8164 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8165 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8166 cannot be forced from the request.
8167
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008168 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008169 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8170 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8171
8172 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8173 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008174
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008175
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008176use-server <server> if <condition>
8177use-server <server> unless <condition>
8178 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8180 no | no | yes | yes
8181 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008182 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008183
8184 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8185
8186 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8187 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8188 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8189
8190 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8191 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8192 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8193 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8194 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8195 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8196 matches will assign the server.
8197
8198 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8199 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8200 with the next rules until one matches.
8201
8202 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8203 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8204 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8205 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8206
8207 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8208 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8209 stripped.
8210
8211 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8212 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8213 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8214 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8215
8216 Example :
8217 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8218 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8219 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8220 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8221 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8222 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8223 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8224 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8225 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8226
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008227 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008228
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008229
82305. Bind and Server options
8231--------------------------
8232
8233The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8234depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8235settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8236written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8237described in this section.
8238
8239
82405.1. Bind options
8241-----------------
8242
8243The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8244as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8245no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8246parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8247while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8248provided immediately after the setting name.
8249
8250The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8251
8252accept-proxy
8253 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008254 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8255 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008256 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8257 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8258 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8259 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8260 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8261 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8262 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008263 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8264 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008265
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008266alpn <protocols>
8267 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8268 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8269 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8270 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8271 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8272 initial NPN extension.
8273
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008274backlog <backlog>
8275 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8276 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8277
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008278ecdhe <named curve>
8279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008280 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8281 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008282
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008283ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8285 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8286 client's certificate.
8287
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008288ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8289 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8290 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8291 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8292 error is ignored.
8293
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008294ciphers <ciphers>
8295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8296 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008297 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008298 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8299 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8300
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008301crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8303 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8304 to verify client's certificate.
8305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008306crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8308 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8309 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8310 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8311 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8312 file.
8313
8314 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8315 are loaded.
8316
8317 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008318 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8319 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008320 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8321 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8322 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8323 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8324 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8325 www.sub.example.org).
8326
8327 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8328 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8329 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8330 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8331 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8332
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008333 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008334
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008335 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8336 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008337 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008338 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8339 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8340 clients).
8341
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008342 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8343 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8344 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8345 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8346 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8347 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8348 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8349 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8350 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8351 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8352 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8353 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8354 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8355
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008356crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8358 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008359 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008360 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008361
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008362crt-list <file>
8363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008364 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8365 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008366
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008367 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008368
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008369 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8370 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8371 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8372 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8373 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8374 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8375 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8376 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008377
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008378defer-accept
8379 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8380 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8381 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8382 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8383 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8384 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8385 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8386 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8387 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8388 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8389 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8390
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008391force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008392 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008393 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008394 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8395 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008396
8397force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008398 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008399 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8400 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008401
8402force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008403 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008404 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8405 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008406
8407force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008408 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008409 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8410 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008411
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008412gid <gid>
8413 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8414 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8415 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8416 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8417 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8418
8419group <group>
8420 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8421 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8422 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8423 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8424 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8425
8426id <id>
8427 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8428 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8429 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8430 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8431
8432interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008433 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8434 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8435 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8436 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8437 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8438 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8439 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008440
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008441level <level>
8442 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8443 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8444 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8445 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8446 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8447 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8448 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8449 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8450 counters).
8451 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8452 all counters).
8453
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008454maxconn <maxconn>
8455 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8456 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8457 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8458 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8459 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8460 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8461 eat all memory.
8462
8463mode <mode>
8464 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8465 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8466 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8467 UNIX sockets.
8468
8469mss <maxseg>
8470 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8471 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8472 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8473 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8474 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8475 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8476 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8477 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8478 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8479 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8480 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8481
8482name <name>
8483 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8484 page.
8485
8486nice <nice>
8487 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8488 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8489 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8490 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8491 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8492 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8493 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8494 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8495 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8496 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8497 one for an RDP socket.
8498
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008499no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008501 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008502 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008503 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8504 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008505 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008506
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008507no-tls-tickets
8508 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8509 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8510 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008511 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8512 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008513
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008514no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008516 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008517 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008518 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8519 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8520 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008521
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008522no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008524 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008525 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008526 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8527 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8528 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008529
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008530no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008531 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008532 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008533 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008534 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8535 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8536 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008537
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008538npn <protocols>
8539 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8540 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8541 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8542 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008543 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8544 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008545
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008546process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8547 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8548 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8549 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8550 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8551 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8552 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8553 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008554 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8555 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8556 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8557 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8558 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8559 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8560 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008561
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008562ssl
8563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008564 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008565 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8566 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8567 to deciphered contents.
8568
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008569strict-sni
8570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8571 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8572 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8573 See the "crt" option for more information.
8574
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008575tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008576 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008577 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8578 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8579 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8580 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8581 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8582 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8583 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008584 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8585 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8586 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008587
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008588transparent
8589 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8590 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8591 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8592 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8593 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8594 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8595 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8596 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8597 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8598 so check for support with your vendor.
8599
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008600v4v6
8601 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8602 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8603 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8604 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008605 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008606
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008607v6only
8608 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8609 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8610 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008611 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8612 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008614uid <uid>
8615 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8616 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8617 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8618 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8619 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8620
8621user <user>
8622 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8623 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8624 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8625 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8626 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8627
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008628verify [none|optional|required]
8629 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8630 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8631 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8632 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8633 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008634 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8635 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8636 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8637 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008638
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086395.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008640------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008642The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8643which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8644arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8645settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8646after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8647Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8648address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008650 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008651 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008653The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008654
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008655addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008656 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8657 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8658 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8659 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8660 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008662 Supported in default-server: No
8663
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008664agent-check
8665 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008666 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8667 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8668 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8669 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008670
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008671 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008672 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008673 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8674 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8675 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008676
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008677 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8678 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008679
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008680 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8681 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8682 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008683
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008684 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8685 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8686 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008687
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008688 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8689 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8690 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8691 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8692 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8693 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8694 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008695
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008696 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8697 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008698
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008699 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8700 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8701 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8702 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8703 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8704 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8705 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8706 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8707 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008708
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008709 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8710 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008711 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8712 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8713 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8714 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008715
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008716 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8717 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008718
8719 Supported in default-server: No
8720
8721agent-inter <delay>
8722 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8723 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8724
8725 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8726 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8727 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8728 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8729 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8730 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8731 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8732 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8733 of backends use the same servers.
8734
8735 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8736
8737 Supported in default-server: Yes
8738
8739agent-port <port>
8740 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8741
8742 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8743
8744 Supported in default-server: Yes
8745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008746backup
8747 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8748 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8749 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8750 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8751 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8752 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008754 Supported in default-server: No
8755
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008756ca-file <cafile>
8757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8758 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8759 server's certificate.
8760
8761 Supported in default-server: No
8762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008763check
8764 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008765 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8766 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8767 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8768 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8769 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8770 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8771 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008772 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8773 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8774 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008775
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008776 Supported in default-server: No
8777
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008778check-send-proxy
8779 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8780 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8781 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8782 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8783 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8784 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8785 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8786
8787 Supported in default-server: No
8788
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008789check-ssl
8790 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8791 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8792 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8793 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008794 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008795 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8796 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8797 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8798 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8799
8800 Supported in default-server: No
8801
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008802ciphers <ciphers>
8803 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008804 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008805 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8806 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8807 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8808 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8809 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8810 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8811
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008812 Supported in default-server: No
8813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008814cookie <value>
8815 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8816 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8817 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8818 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8819 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8820 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8821 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008823 Supported in default-server: No
8824
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008825crl-file <crlfile>
8826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8827 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8828 to verify server's certificate.
8829
8830 Supported in default-server: No
8831
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008832crt <cert>
8833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8834 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8835 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8836 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8837 certificate request.
8838
8839 Supported in default-server: No
8840
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008841disabled
8842 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8843 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8844 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8845 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8846 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8847
8848 Supported in default-server: No
8849
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008850error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008851 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8852 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8853 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008855 Supported in default-server: Yes
8856
8857 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008859fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008860 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8861 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8862 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008864 Supported in default-server: Yes
8865
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008866force-sslv3
8867 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8868 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008869 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8870 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008871
8872 Supported in default-server: No
8873
8874force-tlsv10
8875 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008876 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8877 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008878
8879 Supported in default-server: No
8880
8881force-tlsv11
8882 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008883 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8884 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008885
8886 Supported in default-server: No
8887
8888force-tlsv12
8889 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008890 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8891 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008892
8893 Supported in default-server: No
8894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008895id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008896 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8897 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8898 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008900 Supported in default-server: No
8901
8902inter <delay>
8903fastinter <delay>
8904downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008905 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8906 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8907 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8908 between checks depending on the server state :
8909
8910 Server state | Interval used
8911 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8912 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8913 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8914 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8915 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8916 or yet unchecked. |
8917 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8918 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8919 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008921 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8922 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8923 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8924 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008925 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8926 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8927 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8928 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8929 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008931 Supported in default-server: Yes
8932
8933maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008934 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8935 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8936 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8937 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8938 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8939 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8940 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8941 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008943 Supported in default-server: Yes
8944
8945maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008946 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8947 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8948 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8949 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8950 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8951 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8952 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008954 Supported in default-server: Yes
8955
8956minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008957 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8958 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8959 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8960 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8961 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8962 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008963 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008964 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008966 Supported in default-server: Yes
8967
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008968no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008969 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8970 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008971 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008972
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008973 Supported in default-server: No
8974
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008975no-tls-tickets
8976 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8977 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8978 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008979 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
8980 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008981
8982 Supported in default-server: No
8983
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008984no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008985 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008986 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8987 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008988 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
8989 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
8990 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008991
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008992 Supported in default-server: No
8993
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008994no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008995 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008996 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8997 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008998 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
8999 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9000 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009001
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009002 Supported in default-server: No
9003
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009004no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009005 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009006 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9007 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009008 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9009 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9010 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009011
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009012 Supported in default-server: No
9013
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009014non-stick
9015 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9016 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9017 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9018
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009019 Supported in default-server: No
9020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009021observe <mode>
9022 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9023 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9024 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9025 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9026 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9027 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009028 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009030 Supported in default-server: No
9031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009032 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009034on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009035 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9036 Currently, four modes are available:
9037 - fastinter: force fastinter
9038 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9039 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9040 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9041 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009043 Supported in default-server: Yes
9044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009045 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9046
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009047on-marked-down <action>
9048 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9049 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009050 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9051 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9052 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9053 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9054 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9055 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9056 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9057 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009058
9059 Actions are disabled by default
9060
9061 Supported in default-server: Yes
9062
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009063on-marked-up <action>
9064 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9065 Currently one action is available:
9066 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9067 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9068 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9069 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9070 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9071 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9072 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9073 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9074
9075 Actions are disabled by default
9076
9077 Supported in default-server: Yes
9078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009079port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009080 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9081 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9082 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9083 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9084 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9085 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009087 Supported in default-server: Yes
9088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009089redir <prefix>
9090 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9091 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9092 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9093 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9094 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9095 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9096 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9097 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009098 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009099 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9100 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9101 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9102 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9103 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9104
9105 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009107 Supported in default-server: No
9108
9109rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009110 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9111 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9112 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009114 Supported in default-server: Yes
9115
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009116send-proxy
9117 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9118 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9119 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9120 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9121 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9122 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9123 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9124 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9125 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009126 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9127 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9128 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9129 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9130 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009131
9132 Supported in default-server: No
9133
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009134send-proxy-v2
9135 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9136 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9137 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9138 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9139 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9140 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9141 option of the "bind" keyword.
9142
9143 Supported in default-server: No
9144
9145send-proxy-v2-ssl
9146 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9147 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9148 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9149 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9150 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9151 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9152 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9153 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9154
9155 Supported in default-server: No
9156
9157send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9158 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9159 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9160 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9161 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9162 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9163 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9164 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9165 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9166 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9167
9168 Supported in default-server: No
9169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009170slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009171 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9172 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9173 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9174 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9175 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9176 parameters :
9177
9178 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9179 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9180
9181 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9182 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9183 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9184 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9185
9186 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9187 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9188 seen as failed.
9189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009190 Supported in default-server: Yes
9191
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009192source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009193source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009194source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009195 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9196 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9197 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9198 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9199
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009200 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9201 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9202 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9203 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9204 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9205 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9206 server.
9207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009208 Supported in default-server: No
9209
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009210ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009211 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9212 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9213 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9214 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9215 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9216 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009217 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009218
9219 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009221track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009222 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9223 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9224 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9225 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009226 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009228 Supported in default-server: No
9229
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009230verify [none|required]
9231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009232 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9233 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9234 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9235 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009236 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9237 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9238 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009239
9240 Supported in default-server: No
9241
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009242verifyhost <hostname>
9243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9244 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9245 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9246 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9247 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9248 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9249
9250 Supported in default-server: No
9251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009252weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009253 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9254 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9255 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009256 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9257 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9258 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9259 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9260 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9261 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009263 Supported in default-server: Yes
9264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009265
92666. HTTP header manipulation
9267---------------------------
9268
9269In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9270response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9271request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9272which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009273against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009274
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009275If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9276to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9277but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9278HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9279stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9280because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9281a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9282still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009284This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9285in section 4.2 :
9286
9287 - reqadd <string>
9288 - reqallow <search>
9289 - reqiallow <search>
9290 - reqdel <search>
9291 - reqidel <search>
9292 - reqdeny <search>
9293 - reqideny <search>
9294 - reqpass <search>
9295 - reqipass <search>
9296 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9297 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9298 - reqtarpit <search>
9299 - reqitarpit <search>
9300 - rspadd <string>
9301 - rspdel <search>
9302 - rspidel <search>
9303 - rspdeny <search>
9304 - rspideny <search>
9305 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9306 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9307
9308With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9309is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9310parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9311prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9312Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9313
9314 \t for a tab
9315 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9316 \n for a new line (LF)
9317 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9318 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9319 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9320 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9321 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9322
9323The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9324portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9325above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9326regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93279 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9328is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9329
9330The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9331after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9332
9333Notes related to these keywords :
9334---------------------------------
9335 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9336 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9337 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9338
9339 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9340 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9341 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9342
9343 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9344 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9345 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9346 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9347 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9348
9349 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9350 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9351 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9352 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9353 useless headers before adding new ones.
9354
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009355 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009356 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9357
9358 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9359 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9360 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9361
9362 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9363 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009364 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009365
9366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9368----------------------------------
9369
9370Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9371client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9372The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9373these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9374but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9375data called patterns.
9376
9377
93787.1. ACL basics
9379---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009380
9381The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9382content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9383from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9384simple :
9385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009386 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009387 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009388 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9389 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009391The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9392adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009393
9394In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009396 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009397
9398This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9399Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9400and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009401an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9402conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9403as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9404are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009405
9406ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9407'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9408which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9409
9410There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9411performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009413The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9414specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9415this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009416methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9417ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009418
9419Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9420 - boolean
9421 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9422 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9423 - string
9424 - data block
9425
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009426Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9427converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9428would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9429The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9430which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9431
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009432Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9433keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9434fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9435which are summarized in the table below :
9436
9437 +---------------------+-----------------+
9438 | Sample or converter | Default |
9439 | output type | matching method |
9440 +---------------------+-----------------+
9441 | boolean | bool |
9442 +---------------------+-----------------+
9443 | integer | int |
9444 +---------------------+-----------------+
9445 | ip | ip |
9446 +---------------------+-----------------+
9447 | string | str |
9448 +---------------------+-----------------+
9449 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9450 +---------------------+-----------------+
9451
9452Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9453matching method, see below.
9454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009455The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9456 - boolean
9457 - integer or integer range
9458 - IP address / network
9459 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9460 - regular expression
9461 - hex block
9462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009463The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9464
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009465 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9466 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009467 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009468 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009469 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009470 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009471 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009473The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9474read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9475if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9476lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9477will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9478beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9479a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9480lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9481exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9482
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009483The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9484parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9485ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9486a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9487check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9488
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009489The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9490socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9491file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009493Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9494loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9495
9496 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9497
9498In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9499the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9500case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9501as well.
9502
9503The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9504sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9505do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9506methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9507is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9508obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9509followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9510default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9511that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9512string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9513
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009514The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9515By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9516string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9517resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9518server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9519waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9520flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9521function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009523There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9524sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9525be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009526
9527 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9528 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009529 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9530 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9531 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9532 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009533
9534 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9535 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009536 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009537
9538 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009539 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009540
9541 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009542 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009543
9544 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9545 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9546
9547 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9548 binary or string samples.
9549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009550 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9551 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009553 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9554 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9555 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009557 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9558 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009560 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9561 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009563 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9564 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009566 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9567 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009568 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009570 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9571 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9572 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009573
9574For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9575request, it is possible to do :
9576
9577 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9578
9579In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9580buffer, one would use the following acl :
9581
9582 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9583
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009584On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9585possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9586
9587 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009589All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9590criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9591method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9592to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9593criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9594the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009596If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009597the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9598For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009600 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9601 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9602 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9603 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009604
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009605
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009606The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9607types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9608combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9609brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9610default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009612 +-------------------------------------------------+
9613 | Input sample type |
9614 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009615 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009616 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9617 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9618 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009619 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009620 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009621 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009622 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009623 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009624 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009625 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009626 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009627 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009628 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009629 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009630 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009631 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009632 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009633 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009634 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009635 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009637 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009638 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009639 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009640 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9641 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9642 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009643
9644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096457.1.1. Matching booleans
9646------------------------
9647
9648In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9649Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9650When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9651that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9652
9653Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9654return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9655"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9656
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096587.1.2. Matching integers
9659------------------------
9660
9661Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9662enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9663to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9664
9665Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9666matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9667lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009668
9669For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9670unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9671representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9672
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009673As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9674two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9675instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9676ranges and operators.
9677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009678For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009679operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9680Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9681of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009683Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009684
9685 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9686 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9687 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9688 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9689 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009691For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009692
9693 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9694
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009695This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9696
9697 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9698
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097007.1.3. Matching strings
9701-----------------------
9702
9703String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9704different forms :
9705
9706 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9707 patterns ;
9708
9709 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9710 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9711
9712 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9713 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9714
9715 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9716 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9717
9718 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9719 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9720 matches.
9721
9722 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9723 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9724 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009725
9726String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9727exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9728characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9729string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9730to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009731before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009732
9733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097347.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9735---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009736
9737Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9738they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9739possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9740passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9741the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009742the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9743match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009744
9745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097467.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9747-------------------------------------
9748
9749It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9750not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9751a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9752to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9753digits may be used upper or lower case.
9754
9755Example :
9756 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9757 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9758
9759
97607.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9761---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009762
9763IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9764netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9765within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009766host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009767difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9768at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9769does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9770parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009771
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009772IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9773Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9774trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9775IPv6 patterns.
9776
9777HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9778following situations :
9779 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9780 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9781 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9782 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9783 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9784 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9785 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9786 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9787 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9788 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009790
97917.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9792----------------------------------
9793
9794Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9795combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9796
9797 - AND (implicit)
9798 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9799 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009801A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009803 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009805Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9806indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009808For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9809"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9810requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9811is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9812
9813 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9814 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9815 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9816 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9817
9818To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9819and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9820
9821 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9822 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9823 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9824 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9825
9826 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9827 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9828 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9829 use_backend www if host_www
9830
9831It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9832expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9833be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9834the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9835
9836 The following rule :
9837
9838 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9839 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9840
9841 Can also be written that way :
9842
9843 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9844
9845It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9846to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9847simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9848sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9849good use is the following :
9850
9851 With named ACLs :
9852
9853 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9854 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9855 monitor fail if site_dead
9856
9857 With anonymous ACLs :
9858
9859 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9860
9861See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9862
9863
98647.3. Fetching samples
9865---------------------
9866
9867Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9868against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9869sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9870ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9871of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9872available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9873
9874This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9875Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9876compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9877deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9878
9879The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9880matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9881method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9882indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9883
9884As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9885when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9886mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9887the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9888ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9889
9890Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9891multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9892when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9893incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9894are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9895is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9896all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9897
9898Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9899 - name
9900 - name(arg1)
9901 - name(arg1,arg2)
9902
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009903
99047.3.1. Converters
9905-----------------
9906
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009907Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9908of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9909is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9910was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9911has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9912unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9913
9914These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9915sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9916the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9917support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009919The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009920
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009921base64
9922 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9923 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9924 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9925
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009926hex
9927 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9928 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9929 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9930 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009931
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009932http_date([<offset>])
9933 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9934 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9935 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9936 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9937 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9938 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009939
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009940ipmask(<mask>)
9941 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9942 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9943 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9944 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9945
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009946language(<value>[,<default>])
9947 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9948 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9949 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9950 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9951 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9952 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9953 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9954 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9955 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9956 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9957 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9958 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009959
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009960 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009962 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9963 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009964
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009965 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9966 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9967 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9968 use_backend spanish if es
9969 use_backend french if fr
9970 use_backend english if en
9971 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009972
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009973lower
9974 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9975 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9976 type. The result is of type string.
9977
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009978map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9979map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9980map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9981 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9982 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9983 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9984 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9985 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9986 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9987 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9988 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009989
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009990 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9991 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9992 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009993
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009994 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9995 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009996
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009997 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9998 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9999 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10000 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010001 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10002 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010003 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10004 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10005 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10006 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10007 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10008 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10009 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10010 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10011 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10012 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10013 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10014 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10015 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10016 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010017
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010018 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10019 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10020 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10021 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10022 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010023
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010024 Example :
10025
10026 # this is a comment and is ignored
10027 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10028 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10029 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10030 | | | `---------- value
10031 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10032 | `---------------------------- key
10033 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10034
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010035upper
10036 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10037 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10038 type. The result is of type string.
10039
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010040
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100417.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010042--------------------------------------------
10043
10044A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10045not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10046"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10047The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10048
10049always_false : boolean
10050 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10051 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10052
10053always_true : boolean
10054 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10055 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10056
10057avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010058 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010059 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10060 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10061 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10062 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10063 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10064 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10065 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10066 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10067 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10068 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10069 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10070 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10071 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010073be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010074 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10075 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10076 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10077 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10078 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010080be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10081 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10082 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10083 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10084 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10085 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10086 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010087
10088 Example :
10089 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10090 backend dynamic
10091 mode http
10092 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10093 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010095connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10096 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010097 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010098 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10099 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010100
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010101 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010102 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010103 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10104
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010105 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10106 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010107
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010108 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010109 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010110 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010111 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10112 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010113 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010114 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010115
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010116 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10117 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010119 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010120
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010121date([<offset>]) : integer
10122 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10123 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10124 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10125 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010126 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10127
10128 Example :
10129
10130 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10131 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010132
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010133env(<name>) : string
10134 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10135 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10136 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10137 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10138 certain way.
10139
10140 Examples :
10141 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10142 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10143
10144 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10145 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010147fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10148 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010149 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10150 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10152 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10153 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10154 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10155 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010157fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10158 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10159 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10160 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10161 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10162 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10163 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10164 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10165 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010166
10167 Example :
10168 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10169 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10170 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10171 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10172 frontend mail
10173 bind :25
10174 mode tcp
10175 maxconn 100
10176 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10177 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10178 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10179 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010180
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010181nbproc : integer
10182 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10183 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10184 and debugging purposes.
10185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010186nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10187 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10188 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10189 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010190 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10191 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10192 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010193
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010194proc : integer
10195 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10196 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10197 debugging purposes.
10198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010199queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010200 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10201 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10202 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010203 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10204 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10205 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10206 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10207 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10208
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010209rand([<range>]) : integer
10210 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10211 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10212 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10213 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10214 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010216srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10217 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10218 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10219 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10220 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10221 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10222 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10223 methods.
10224
10225srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10226 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10227 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10228 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10229 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10230 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10231 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10232 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10233
10234srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10235 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10236 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010237 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010238 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10239 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10240 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10241 overloading servers).
10242
10243 Example :
10244 # Redirect to a separate back
10245 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10246 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10247 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10248
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010249stopping : boolean
10250 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10251 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10252 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010254table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10255 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10256 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10257
10258table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10259 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10260 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10261 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10262
10263
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102647.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010265----------------------------------
10266
10267The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10268closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10269methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10270sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10271TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010272the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10273counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10274"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010275argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10276the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10277this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010278
10279be_id : integer
10280 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10281 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10282
10283dst : ip
10284 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10285 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10286 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10287 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10288 RFC 4291.
10289
10290dst_conn : integer
10291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10292 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10293 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10294 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10295 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10296 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10297 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10298 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010300dst_port : integer
10301 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10302 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10303 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10304 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10305 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10306 an HTTP header.
10307
10308fe_id : integer
10309 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10310 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10311 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10312
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010313sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010314sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10315sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10316sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010317 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10318 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10319 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10320
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010321sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010322sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10323sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10324sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010325 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10326 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10327 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10328
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010329sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010330sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10331sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10332sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010333 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10334 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010335 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10336 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10337 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010338
10339 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10340 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010341 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10342 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10343 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010344 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10345 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10346
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010347sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010348sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10349sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10350sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010351 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10352 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10353
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010354sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010355sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10356sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10357sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010358 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10359 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10360 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010362sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010363sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10364sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10365sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010366 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10367 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10368 See also src_conn_rate.
10369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010370sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010371sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10372sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10373sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010374 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010375 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010377sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010378sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10379sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10380sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010381 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10382 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10383 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010384 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10385 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10386 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010387
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010388sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010389sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10390sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10391sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010392 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10393 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10394 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10395
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010396sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010397sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10398sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10399sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010400 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10401 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10402 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10403 src_http_err_rate.
10404
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010405sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010406sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10407sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10408sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010409 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10410 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10411 src_http_req_cnt.
10412
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010413sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010414sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10415sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10416sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010417 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10418 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10419 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10420 src_http_req_rate.
10421
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010422sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010423sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10424sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10425sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010426 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010427 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10428 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10429 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10430 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010431
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010432 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10433 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010434 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010436sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010437sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10438sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10439sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010440 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10441 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10442 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010443
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010444sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010445sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10446sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10447sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010448 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10449 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10450 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010451
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010452sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010453sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10454sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10455sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010456 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10457 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10458 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10459 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010460 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010461 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10462
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010463sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010464sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10465sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10466sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010467 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10468 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10469 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10470 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10471 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010472 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010473
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010474sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010475sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10476sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10477sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010478 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10479 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10480 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10481
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010482sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010483sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10484sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10485sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010486 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10487 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010488 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010489 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10490 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010491 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10492 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10493 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010495so_id : integer
10496 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10497 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10498 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010500src : ip
10501 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10502 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10503 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10504 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10505 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10506 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10507 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010508
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010509 Example:
10510 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10511 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10514 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10515 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10516 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010517 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010519src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10520 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10521 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010522 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010523 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010525src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10526 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10527 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10528 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10529 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10530 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10531 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010532
10533 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10534 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10535 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10536 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010537 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010538 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10539 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010542 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010543 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010544 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010545 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010547src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010548 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010549 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10550 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010551 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010553src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10554 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10555 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10556 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010557 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010559src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010560 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010561 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010562 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010563 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010565src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010566 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010567 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010568 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10569 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010570 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10571 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10572 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10575 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10576 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010577 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010578 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010579 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10582 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10583 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10584 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10585 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010586 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010588src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10589 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10590 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10591 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010592 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010594src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10595 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10596 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10597 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010598 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010599 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010601src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10602 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10603 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10604 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010605 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010606 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10607 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010608
10609 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010610 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010611 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010613src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010614 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10615 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10616 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10617 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10618 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010620src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010621 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10622 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10623 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10624 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10625 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010627src_port : integer
10628 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10629 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10630 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10631 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010633src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10634 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010635 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10636 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10637 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010638 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010640src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10641 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10642 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10643 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10644 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010645 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010647src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10648 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10649 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10650 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10651 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10652 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10653 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10654 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10655 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010656
10657 Example :
10658 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10659 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10660 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10661 listen ssh
10662 bind :22
10663 mode tcp
10664 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010665 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010666 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010667 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010669srv_id : integer
10670 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10671 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10672 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010673
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010674
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010676----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010678The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10679closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10680when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10681usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010682future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010683
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010684ssl_bc : boolean
10685 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10686 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10687 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10688
10689ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10690 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10691 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10692
10693ssl_bc_cipher : string
10694 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10695 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10696
10697ssl_bc_protocol : string
10698 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10699 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10700
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010701ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010702 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010703 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10704 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010705
10706ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10707 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10708 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10709 if session was reused or not.
10710
10711ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10712 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10713 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010715ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10716 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10717 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10718 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10719 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10720 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010722ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10723 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10724 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10725 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10726 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010727
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010728ssl_c_der : binary
10729 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10730 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10731 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010733ssl_c_err : integer
10734 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10735 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10736 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10737 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10738 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010740ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10741 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10742 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10743 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10744 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10745 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10746 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10747 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10748 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010750ssl_c_key_alg : string
10751 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10752 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10753 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010755ssl_c_notafter : string
10756 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10757 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10758 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010760ssl_c_notbefore : string
10761 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10762 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10763 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010765ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10766 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10767 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10768 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10769 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10770 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10771 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10772 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10773 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010775ssl_c_serial : binary
10776 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10777 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10778 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010780ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10781 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10782 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10783 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010784 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10785 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10786
10787 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010789ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10790 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10791 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10792 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010794ssl_c_used : boolean
10795 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10796 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010798ssl_c_verify : integer
10799 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10800 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10801 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10802 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010804ssl_c_version : integer
10805 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10806 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010807
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010808ssl_f_der : binary
10809 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10810 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10811 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010813ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10814 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10815 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10816 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10817 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010818 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010819 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10820 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10821 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010823ssl_f_key_alg : string
10824 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10825 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10826 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010828ssl_f_notafter : string
10829 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10830 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10831 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010833ssl_f_notbefore : string
10834 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10835 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10836 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010838ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10839 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10840 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10841 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10842 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10843 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10844 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10845 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10846 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010848ssl_f_serial : binary
10849 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10850 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10851 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010852
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010853ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10854 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10855 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10856 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010858ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10859 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10860 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10861 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010863ssl_f_version : integer
10864 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10865 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10866
10867ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010868 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10869 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10870 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010872 Example :
10873 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10874 listen http-https
10875 bind :80
10876 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10877 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10878
10879ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10880 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10881 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10882
10883ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010884 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010885 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10886 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10887 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10888 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10889 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10890 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10891 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10892 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010894ssl_fc_cipher : string
10895 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10896 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010898ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010899 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10900 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010901 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10902 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10903 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10904 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010906ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10907 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010908 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10909 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10910 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10911 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010914 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010915 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10916 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10917 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10918 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10919 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10920 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10921 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010923ssl_fc_protocol : string
10924 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10925 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010926
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010927ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010928 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010929 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10930 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010932ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10933 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10934 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10935 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10936 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010938ssl_fc_sni : string
10939 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10940 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10941 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10942 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10943 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10944
10945 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10946 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10947 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010948 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10949 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010952 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10953 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010955ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10956 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10957 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010958
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010959
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109607.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010961------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010963Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10964sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10965only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10966For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10967be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10968can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10969sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10970for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10971content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010973payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10974 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10975 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10976 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010978payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10979 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10980 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10981 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010983req.len : integer
10984req_len : integer (deprecated)
10985 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10986 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10987 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10988 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10989 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10990 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10991 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10992 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010994req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10995 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010996 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10997 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10998 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10999 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011001 ACL alternatives :
11002 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011004req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11005 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11006 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11007 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11008 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011010 ACL alternatives :
11011 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011013 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011015req.proto_http : boolean
11016req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11017 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11018 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11019 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11020 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11021 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11022 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11023 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011025 Example:
11026 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11027 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11028 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011029 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011031req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11032rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11033 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11034 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11035 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11036 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11037 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11038 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11039 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011041 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11042 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11043 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11044 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11045 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11046 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048 ACL derivatives :
11049 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011051 Example :
11052 listen tse-farm
11053 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11054 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11055 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11056 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11057 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11058 persist rdp-cookie
11059 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11060 # This is only useful makes sense if
11061 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11062 stick-table type string size 204800
11063 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11064 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11065 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011067 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11068 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011070req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11071rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11072 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11073 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11074 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11075 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011077 ACL derivatives :
11078 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011080req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11081req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11082 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11083 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11084 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11085 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11086 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11087 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11088 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011090req.ssl_sni : string
11091req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11092 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11093 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11094 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11095 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11096 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11097 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11098 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11099 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11100 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11101 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11102 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11103 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011105 ACL derivatives :
11106 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011108 Examples :
11109 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11110 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11111 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11112 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11113 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011115res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11116rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11117 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11118 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11119 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11120 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11121 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11122 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11123 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011125req.ssl_ver : integer
11126req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11127 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11128 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11129 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11130 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11131 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11132 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11133 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11134 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11135 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011137 ACL derivatives :
11138 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011139
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011140res.len : integer
11141 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11142 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11143 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11144 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11145 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11146 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11147 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11148 content inspection.
11149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011150res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11151 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011152 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11153 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11154 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11155 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011157res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11158 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11159 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11160 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11161 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011165wait_end : boolean
11166 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11167 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11168 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11169 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11170 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11171 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11172 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11173 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011175 Examples :
11176 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11177 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11178 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011180 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11181 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11182 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11183 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11184 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11185 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11186 tcp-request content reject
11187
11188
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011190--------------------------------------
11191
11192It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11193This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11194data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11195its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11196HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11197content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11198to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11199more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11200response are indexed.
11201
11202base : string
11203 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11204 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11205 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11206 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11207 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11208 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11209 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11210 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11211
11212 ACL derivatives :
11213 base : exact string match
11214 base_beg : prefix match
11215 base_dir : subdir match
11216 base_dom : domain match
11217 base_end : suffix match
11218 base_len : length match
11219 base_reg : regex match
11220 base_sub : substring match
11221
11222base32 : integer
11223 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11224 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11225 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11226 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11227
11228base32+src : binary
11229 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11230 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11231 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11232 per-URL counters.
11233
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011234capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11235 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11236 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11237 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11238
11239capture.req.method : string
11240 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11241 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11242 because it's allocated.
11243
11244capture.req.uri : string
11245 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11246 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11247 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11248 allocated.
11249
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011250capture.req.ver : string
11251 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11252 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11253 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11254
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011255capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11256 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11257 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11258 The first entry is an index of 0.
11259 See also: "capture response header"
11260
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011261capture.res.ver : string
11262 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11263 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11264 persistent flag.
11265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011266req.cook([<name>]) : string
11267cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11268 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11269 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11270 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11271 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11272 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11273 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11274 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11275 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11276
11277 ACL derivatives :
11278 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11279 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11280 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11281 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11282 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11283 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11284 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11285 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011287req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11288cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11289 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11290 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011292req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11293cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11294 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11295 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11296 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11297 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011299cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11300 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11301 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11302 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11303 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11304 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11305 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11306 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11307 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11308 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11309 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011311hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11312 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11313 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11314 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11315 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011316 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011318req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11319 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11320 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11321 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11322 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11323 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11324 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11325 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11326 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11329 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11330 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11331 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11332 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011334req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11335 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11336 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11337 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11338 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11339 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11340 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11341 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11342 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11343 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11344 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11345 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011347 ACL derivatives :
11348 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11349 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11350 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11351 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11352 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11353 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11354 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11355 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11356
11357req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11358hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11359 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11360 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11361 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11362 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11363 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11364 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11365 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11366 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11367 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11368
11369req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11370hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11371 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11372 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11373 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11374 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11375 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11376 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11377 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11378 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11379
11380req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11381hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11382 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11383 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11384 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11385 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11386 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11387 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11388 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11389
11390http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11391 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11392 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11393 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11394 basic auth is supported.
11395
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011396http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11397 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11398 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11399 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11400 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011401 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11402 basic auth is supported.
11403
11404 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011405 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11406 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11407 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11408 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011409
11410http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011411 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11412 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011413 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11414 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011416method : integer + string
11417 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11418 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11419 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11420 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11421 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11422 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11423 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011425 ACL derivatives :
11426 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011428 Example :
11429 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11430 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11431 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011433path : string
11434 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11435 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11436 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11437 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11438 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11439 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11440 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442 ACL derivatives :
11443 path : exact string match
11444 path_beg : prefix match
11445 path_dir : subdir match
11446 path_dom : domain match
11447 path_end : suffix match
11448 path_len : length match
11449 path_reg : regex match
11450 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011452req.ver : string
11453req_ver : string (deprecated)
11454 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11455 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11456 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011458 ACL derivatives :
11459 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011461res.comp : boolean
11462 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11463 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11464 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011466res.comp_algo : string
11467 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11468 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11469 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011471res.cook([<name>]) : string
11472scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11473 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11474 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11475 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011477 ACL derivatives :
11478 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011480res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11481scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11482 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11483 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11484 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011486res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11487scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11488 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11489 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11490 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011492res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11493 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11494 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11495 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11496 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11497 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11498 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11499 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11500 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11501 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011503res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11504 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11505 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11506 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11507 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11508 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011510res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11511shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11512 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11513 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11514 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11515 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11516 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11517 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11518 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11519 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521 ACL derivatives :
11522 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11523 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11524 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11525 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11526 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11527 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11528 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11529 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11530
11531res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11532shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11533 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11534 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11535 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11536 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11537 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011539res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11540shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11541 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11542 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11543 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11544 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11545 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11546 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011548res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11549shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11550 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11551 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11552 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11553 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11554 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11555 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011557res.ver : string
11558resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11559 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11560 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011562 ACL derivatives :
11563 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11566 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11567 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11568 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11569 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011571 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11572 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011574 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011576status : integer
11577 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11578 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11579 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011581url : string
11582 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11583 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11584 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11585 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11586 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11587 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11588 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011590 ACL derivatives :
11591 url : exact string match
11592 url_beg : prefix match
11593 url_dir : subdir match
11594 url_dom : domain match
11595 url_end : suffix match
11596 url_len : length match
11597 url_reg : regex match
11598 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011600url_ip : ip
11601 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11602 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11603 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11604 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11605 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11606 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11607 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011609url_port : integer
11610 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11611 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11612 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11613 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011615urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11616url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11617 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11618 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11619 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11620 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11621 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11622 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11623 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11624 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11625 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011627 ACL derivatives :
11628 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11629 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11630 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11631 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11632 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11633 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11634 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11635 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011636
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011638 Example :
11639 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11640 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11641 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11642 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011644urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11645 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11646 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11647 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011648
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116507.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011651---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011653Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11654every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011655order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011657ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11658---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011659FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011660HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011661HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11662HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011663HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11664HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11665HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11666HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11667LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011668METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11669METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11670METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11671METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11672METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11673METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011674RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011675REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011676TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011677WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11678---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011679
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116818. Logging
11682----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011683
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011684One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11685provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11686very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11687provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11688state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011689to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011690headers.
11691
11692In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11693about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11694send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11695
11696 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11697 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11698 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11699 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11700 at the termination.
11701
11702The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11703allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11704as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11705while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11706real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11707delay.
11708
11709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117108.1. Log levels
11711---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011712
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011713TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011714source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011715HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11716in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11717track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11718syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11719about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011720
11721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117228.2. Log formats
11723----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011724
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011725HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011726and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11727slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11728options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011729
11730 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11731 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11732 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11733 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11734 extents.
11735
11736 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11737 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11738 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11739 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11740 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11741
11742 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11743 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11744 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11745 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11746 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11747
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011748 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11749 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11750 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11751 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11752
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011753 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11754
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011755Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11756specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11757field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11758servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11759always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11760identifier.
11761
11762Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11763 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11764 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11765 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11766 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11767
11768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117698.2.1. Default log format
11770-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011771
11772This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11773as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11774format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11775
11776 Example :
11777 listen www
11778 mode http
11779 log global
11780 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11781
11782 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11783 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11784 (www/HTTP)
11785
11786 Field Format Extract from the example above
11787 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11788 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11789 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11790 4 'to' to
11791 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11792 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11793
11794Detailed fields description :
11795 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11796 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11797 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11798 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11799 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11800 and processed the connection.
11801 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11802
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011803In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11804"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11805connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11806
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011807It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11808will eventually disappear.
11809
11810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118118.2.2. TCP log format
11812---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011813
11814The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11815is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11816information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11817counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11818emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11819environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11820the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11821sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011822specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11823not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11824fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11825marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011826
11827 Example :
11828 frontend fnt
11829 mode tcp
11830 option tcplog
11831 log global
11832 default_backend bck
11833
11834 backend bck
11835 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11836
11837 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11838 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11839 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11840
11841 Field Format Extract from the example above
11842 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11843 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11844 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11845 4 frontend_name fnt
11846 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11847 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11848 7 bytes_read* 212
11849 8 termination_state --
11850 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11851 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11852
11853Detailed fields description :
11854 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011855 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11856 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11857 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11858 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11859 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011860
11861 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011862 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11863 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11864 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011865
11866 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11867 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11868 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11869 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11870
11871 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11872 and processed the connection.
11873
11874 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11875 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11876 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11877 applications.
11878
11879 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11880 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11881 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11882 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11883 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11884
11885 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11886 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11887 See "Timers" below for more details.
11888
11889 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11890 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11891 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11892 "Timers" below for more details.
11893
11894 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011895 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011896 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11897 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11898 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11899 details.
11900
11901 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11902 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11903 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11904 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11905 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11906
11907 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11908 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11909 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11910 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11911 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11912 for more details.
11913
11914 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011915 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011916 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11917 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11918 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011919 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011920
11921 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11922 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11923 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11924 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11925 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11926 caused by a denial of service attack.
11927
11928 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11929 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11930 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11931 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11932 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11933 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11934 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11935 denial of service attack.
11936
11937 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11938 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11939 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11940 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11941 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11942 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11943 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11944 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11945 be processed than on other servers.
11946
11947 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11948 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11949 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11950 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11951 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11952 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11953 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11954 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11955 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11956 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11957 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11958 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11959 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11960
11961 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11962 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11963 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11964 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11965 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11966 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11967 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11968 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11969
11970 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11971 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11972 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11973 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11974 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11975 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11976 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11977 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11978 occurs.
11979
11980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119818.2.3. HTTP log format
11982----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011983
11984The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11985is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11986the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11987are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11988emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11989generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11990"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11991which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011992frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11993is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011994
11995Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11996slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11997with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11998
11999 Example :
12000 frontend http-in
12001 mode http
12002 option httplog
12003 log global
12004 default_backend bck
12005
12006 backend static
12007 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12008
12009 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12010 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12011 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012012 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012013
12014 Field Format Extract from the example above
12015 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12016 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12017 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12018 4 frontend_name http-in
12019 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12020 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12021 7 status_code 200
12022 8 bytes_read* 2750
12023 9 captured_request_cookie -
12024 10 captured_response_cookie -
12025 11 termination_state ----
12026 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12027 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12028 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12029 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12030 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012031
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012032
12033Detailed fields description :
12034 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012035 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12036 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12037 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12038 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12039 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012040
12041 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012042 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12043 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12044 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012045
12046 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12047 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12048 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12049 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12050 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12051
12052 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12053 and processed the connection.
12054
12055 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12056 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12057 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12058
12059 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12060 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12061 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12062 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12063 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12064 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12065
12066 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12067 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12068 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12069 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12070 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12071 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12072
12073 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12074 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12075 See "Timers" below for more details.
12076
12077 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12078 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12079 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12080 below for more details.
12081
12082 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12083 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12084 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12085 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12086 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12087 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12088 for more details.
12089
12090 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012091 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012092 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12093 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12094 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12095 details.
12096
12097 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12098 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12099 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12100
12101 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12102 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12103 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12104 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12105 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12106 overflowing.
12107
12108 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12109 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12110 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12111 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12112 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12113 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12114 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12115 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12116
12117 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12118 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12119 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12120 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12121 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12122 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12123 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12124 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12125
12126 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12127 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12128 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12129 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12130 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12131 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12132 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12133
12134 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012135 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012136 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12137 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12138 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012139 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012140 system.
12141
12142 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12143 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12144 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12145 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12146 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12147 caused by a denial of service attack.
12148
12149 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12150 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12151 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12152 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12153 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12154 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12155 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12156 denial of service attack.
12157
12158 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12159 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12160 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12161 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12162 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12163 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12164 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12165 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12166 processed than on other servers.
12167
12168 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12169 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12170 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12171 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12172 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12173 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12174 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12175 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12176 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12177 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12178 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12179 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12180 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12181
12182 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12183 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12184 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12185 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12186 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12187 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12188 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12189 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12190
12191 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12192 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12193 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12194 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12195 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12196 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12197 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12198 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12199 occurs.
12200
12201 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12202 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12203 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12204 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12205 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12206 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12207 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12208 cookies" below for more details.
12209
12210 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12211 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12212 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12213 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12214 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12215 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12216 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12217 and cookies" below for more details.
12218
12219 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12220 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12221 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12222 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12223 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12224 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12225 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12226 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12227
12228
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122298.2.4. Custom log format
12230------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012231
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012232The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012233mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012234
12235HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12236Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12237separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12238prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12239
12240Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12241variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12242string formats ("Q").
12243
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012244If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012245as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012246less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12247the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12248
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012249Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012250In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012251in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012252
12253Flags are :
12254 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012255 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012256
12257 Example:
12258
12259 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12260 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12261
12262At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12263
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012264 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12265 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012266
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012267the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012268
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012269 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012270 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012271 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012272
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012273and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12274
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012275 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012276 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12277
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012278Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12279
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012280 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012281 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012282 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12283 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12284 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012285 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12286 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12287 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012288 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012289 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012290 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012291 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012292 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012293 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012294 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12295 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012296 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012297 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12298 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012299 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012300 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12301 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012302 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12303 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12304 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012305 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012306 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12307 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012308 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012309 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12310 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12311 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012312 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012313 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12314 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12315 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12316 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012317 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012318 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012319 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012320 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012321 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012322 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012323 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12324 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12325 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012326 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012327 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12328 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012329 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012330 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012331 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012332 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012333
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012334 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012335
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012336
123378.2.5. Error log format
12338-----------------------
12339
12340When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12341protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12342By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12343"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12344will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12345logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12346
12347The format looks like this :
12348
12349 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12350 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12351 Connection error during SSL handshake
12352
12353 Field Format Extract from the example above
12354 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12355 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12356 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12357 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12358 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12359
12360These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12361failures.
12362
12363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123648.3. Advanced logging options
12365-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012366
12367Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12368just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12369options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12370for more information about their usage.
12371
12372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123738.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12374------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012375
12376It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12377haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12378commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12379monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12380ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12381
12382 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12383 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12384 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12385 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12386
12387 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12388 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12389 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012390 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012391 such as other load-balancers.
12392
12393 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12394 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12395 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12396
12397
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123988.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12399----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012400
12401The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12402what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12403or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12404"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12405just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12406log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12407after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12408is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12409with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12410with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12411
12412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124138.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12414------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012415
12416Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12417for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12418"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12419retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12420raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12421a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12422file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12423you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12424"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12425
12426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124278.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12428--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012429
12430Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12431multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12432them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12433"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12434logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12435error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12436and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12437too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12438useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12439alternative.
12440
12441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124428.4. Timing events
12443------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012444
12445Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12446reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12447the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12448frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12449mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12450
12451 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12452 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12453 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12454 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12455 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12456
12457 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12458 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12459 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12460 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12461 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12462
12463 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12464 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12465 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12466 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12467 connection never established.
12468
12469 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12470 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12471 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12472 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12473 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12474 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12475 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12476 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12477 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12478 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12479 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12480
12481 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12482 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12483 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12484 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012485 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012486
12487 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12488
12489 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12490 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12491 negative.
12492
12493These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12494protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12495that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012496due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012497close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12498session has been aborted on timeout.
12499
12500Most common cases :
12501
12502 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12503 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12504 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12505 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12506 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12507 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12508 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12509 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12510 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012511 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12512 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12513 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012514
12515 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12516 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12517 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12518 of ms on remote networks.
12519
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012520 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12521 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12522 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012523
12524 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12525 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12526 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12527 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12528 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12529 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12530 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12531 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12532 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12533 to the server until another one is released.
12534
12535Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12536
12537 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12538 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12539 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12540
12541 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12542 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12543 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12544
12545 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12546 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12547 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12548 flags.
12549
12550 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12551 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12552 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12553 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12554 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12555 the client connection was maintained open.
12556
12557 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012558 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012559 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12560 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12561
12562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125638.5. Session state at disconnection
12564-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012565
12566TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12567"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125682-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12569each of which has a special meaning :
12570
12571 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12572 session to terminate :
12573
12574 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12575
12576 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12577 server explicitly refused it.
12578
12579 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12580 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12581 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12582 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012583 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12584
12585 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12586 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012587
12588 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12589 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12590 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12591 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12592 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12593
12594 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12595 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12596 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12597 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12598 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12599
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012600 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12601 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12602
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012603 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12604 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12605 backup connections when going up.
12606
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012607 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12608
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012609 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12610 send or receive data.
12611
12612 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12613 send or receive data.
12614
12615 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12616 with nothing left in the buffers.
12617
12618 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12619
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012620 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012621 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12622
12623 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12624 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12625 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12626 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12627 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12628
12629 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12630 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12631
12632 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12633 server (HTTP only).
12634
12635 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12636
12637 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12638 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12639 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12640
12641 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12642 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12643 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12644
12645 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12646
12647 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12648 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12649
12650 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12651 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12652 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12653
12654 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12655 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012656 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12657 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012658
12659 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12660 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12661 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12662 another server.
12663
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012664 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012665 server.
12666
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012667 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12668 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12669 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12670 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12671
12672 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12673 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12674 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12675 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12676
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012677 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12678 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12679 "use-server" rule).
12680
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012681 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12682
12683 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12684 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12685
12686 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12687
12688 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12689 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12690 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12691
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012692 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12693 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012694 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012695 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12696 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12697
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012698 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12699
12700 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12701 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12702
12703 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12704
12705 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12706
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012707The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12708was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012709helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12710starvation, attacks, etc...
12711
12712The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12713alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12714easier finding and understanding.
12715
12716 Flags Reason
12717
12718 -- Normal termination.
12719
12720 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12721 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12722 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12723 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12724
12725 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12726 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12727 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12728 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12729 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12730 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012731
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012732 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12733 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012734 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012735
12736 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12737 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12738 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12739
12740 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12741 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12742 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12743 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12744 the server takes too long to respond.
12745
12746 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12747 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12748 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12749 long a time to respond.
12750
12751 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12752 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12753 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12754 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12755 and the client.
12756
12757 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12758 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12759 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12760 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12761 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012762 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12763 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12764 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12765 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12766 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12767 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12768 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12769 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12770 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12771 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12772 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12773 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12774 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12775 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012776
12777 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12778 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012779 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12780 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12781 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12782 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012783
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012784 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12785 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012787 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012788 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12789 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12790 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12791 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12792 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12793
12794 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12795 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12796 503 or 504 here.
12797
12798 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12799 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12800 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12801 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12802 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12803
12804 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12805 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012806 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012807 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12808 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12809
12810 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12811 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12812 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12813 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12814 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12815 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12816 between haproxy and the server.
12817
12818 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12819 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12820 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12821 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12822 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12823 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12824 solution is to fix the application.
12825
12826 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12827 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12828 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12829 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12830 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12831 external attacks.
12832
12833 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12834 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012835 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012836 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12837 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12838
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012839 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12840 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12841 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012842 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12843 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012844
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012845 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12846 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12847 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12848 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012849 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12850 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12851 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12852 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12853 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012854
12855 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12856 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12857 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12858 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12859
12860 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12861 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12862 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12863 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12864
12865 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12866 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12867 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12868 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12869
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012870The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12871persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12872important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12873re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12874
12875 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12876
12877 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12878 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12879 set on a GET request.
12880
12881 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12882 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012883 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012884 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12885
12886 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12887 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12888 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12889
12890 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12891 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12892 already got a cookie.
12893
12894 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12895 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12896 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12897 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12898 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12899
12900 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12901 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12902 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12903
12904 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12905 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12906 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12907
12908 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12909 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12910
12911 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12912 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12913 then advertised in the response.
12914
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129168.6. Non-printable characters
12917-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012918
12919In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12920consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12921converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12922prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12923being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12924escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12925is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12926'}' when logging headers.
12927
12928Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12929issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12930containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12931
12932Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12933the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12934performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12935
12936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129378.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12938---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012939
12940Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12941achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012942section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012943cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12944the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12945the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012946locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012947not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12948user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12949a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12950wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12951
12952 Examples :
12953 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12954 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12955
12956 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12957 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12958
12959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129608.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12961---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012962
12963Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12964proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12965the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12966server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12967
12968Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12969response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012970section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012971
12972It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012973time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12974appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012975are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12976and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12977follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12978request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12979in the logs.
12980
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012981As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12982frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12983an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12984
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012985 Example :
12986 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12987 listen proxy-out
12988 mode http
12989 option httplog
12990 option logasap
12991 log global
12992 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12993
12994 # log the name of the virtual server
12995 capture request header Host len 20
12996
12997 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12998 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12999
13000 # log the beginning of the referrer
13001 capture request header Referer len 20
13002
13003 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13004 capture response header Server len 20
13005
13006 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13007 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13008
13009 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13010 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13011
13012 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13013 capture response header Via len 20
13014
13015 # log the URL location during a redirection
13016 capture response header Location len 20
13017
13018 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13019 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13020 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13021 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13022 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13023
13024 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13025 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13026 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13027 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013028 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013029
13030 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13031 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13032 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13033 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13034 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013035 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013036
13037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130388.9. Examples of logs
13039---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013040
13041These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13042them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13043reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13044
13045 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13046 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13047 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13048
13049 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13050 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13051
13052 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13053 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13054 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13055
13056 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13057 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13058
13059 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13060 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13061 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13062
13063 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013064 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013065 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13066 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13067
13068 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13069 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13070 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13071
13072 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13073 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013074 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013075 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13076 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13077 to return the 502 and not the server.
13078
13079 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013080 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013081
13082 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13083 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13084 Nothing was sent to any server.
13085
13086 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13087 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13088
13089 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13090 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13091 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13092 send a 408 return code to the client.
13093
13094 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13095 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13096
13097 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13098 5 seconds ("c----").
13099
13100 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13101 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013102 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013103
13104 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013105 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013106 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13107 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13108 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13109 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13110 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013111
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131139. Statistics and monitoring
13114----------------------------
13115
13116It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13117mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13118CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13119Unix socket.
13120
13121
131229.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013123---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013124
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013125The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013126page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13127begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13128represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13129use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13130('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13131(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13132text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13133do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13134use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013135
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013136In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13137that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13138S (Servers).
13139
13140 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13141 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13142 any name for server/listener)
13143 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13144 number queued without a server assigned.
13145 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13146 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13147 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13148 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13149 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13150 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13151 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13152 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13153 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13154 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13155 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13156 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13157 "option checkcache".
13158 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13159 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13160 - read error from the client
13161 - client timeout
13162 - client closed connection
13163 - various bad requests from the client.
13164 - request was tarpitted.
13165 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13166 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13167 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13168 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13169 active servers).
13170 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13171 Some other errors are:
13172 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13173 - failure applying filters to the response.
13174 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13175 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13176 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13177 switched away from.
13178 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13179 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13180 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13181 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13182 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13183 the server is up.)
13184 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13185 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13186 counters for each server.
13187 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13188 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13189 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13190 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13191 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13192 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13193 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13194 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13195 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13196 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13197 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13198 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13199 of times that server was selected.
13200 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13201 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13202 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13203 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13204 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13205 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013206 UNK -> unknown
13207 INI -> initializing
13208 SOCKERR -> socket error
13209 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13210 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13211 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13212 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13213 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13214 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13215 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13216 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13217 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13218 disable-on-404
13219 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13220 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13221 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013222 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13223 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13224 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13225 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13226 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13227 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13228 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13229 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13230 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13231 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13232 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13233 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13234 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13235 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13236 (inc. in eresp)
13237 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13238 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13239 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13240 (CPU/BW limit)
13241 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13242 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13243 server/backend
13244 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13245 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13246 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13247 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13248 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13249 (0 for TCP)
13250 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13251 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013252
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132549.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013255-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013256
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013257The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13258necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13259A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13260issuing commands by hand :
13261
13262 global
13263 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13264 stats timeout 2m
13265
13266It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13267the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13268never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13269situations :
13270
13271 global
13272 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13273 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13274 stats timeout 2m
13275
13276To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13277swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13278to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13279syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13280
13281 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13282 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13283
13284The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13285script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13286for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13287
13288The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13289that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13290editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13291(eg: watch a counter).
13292
13293The socket supports two operation modes :
13294 - interactive
13295 - non-interactive
13296
13297The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13298this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13299sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13300mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13301commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13302example :
13303
13304 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13305
13306The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13307entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13308for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13309sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13310"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13311after processing the last command of the same line.
13312
13313For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13314"prompt" command :
13315
13316 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13317 prompt
13318 > show info
13319 ...
13320 >
13321
13322Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13323delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13324that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13325parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013326
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013327It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13328on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13329own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013330
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013331The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13332If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13333all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13334it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13335
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013336add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013337 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13338 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13339 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13340 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013341
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013342add map <map> <key> <value>
13343 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13344 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013345 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13346 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13347 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013348
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013349clear counters
13350 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13351 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13352 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13353 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13354 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13355
13356clear counters all
13357 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13358 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13359 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13360
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013361clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013362 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13363 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13364 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013365
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013366clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013367 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13368 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13369 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013370
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013371clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13372 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13373
13374 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13375 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13376 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13377 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13378 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13379 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13380
13381 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13382
13383 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13384 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13385 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13386 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13387 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13388 the ACLs :
13389
13390 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13391 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13392 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13393 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13394 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13395 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13396
13397 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013398 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13399 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013400
13401 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013402 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013403 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013404 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13405 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13406 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13407 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013408
13409 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13410
13411 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013412 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013413 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13414 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013415 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13416 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13417 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013418
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013419del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13420 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013421 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13422 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13423 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13424 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013425
13426del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013427 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013428 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13429 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13430 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13431 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013432
13433disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013434 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13435
13436 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13437 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13438 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13439 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13440 re-enabled using enable agent.
13441
13442 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13443 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13444 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13445 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13446 otherwise unchanged.
13447
13448 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13449 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13450 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13451
13452 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13453 level "admin".
13454
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013455disable frontend <frontend>
13456 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13457 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13458 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13459 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13460 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13461 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13462 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13463 on the stats page.
13464
13465 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13466 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13467
13468 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13469 level "admin".
13470
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013471disable health <backend>/<server>
13472 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13473 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13474 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13475 agent check forces it down.
13476
13477 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13478 level "admin".
13479
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013480disable server <backend>/<server>
13481 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13482 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13483 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13484 during the maintenance.
13485
13486 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13487 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13488
13489 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013490 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013491
13492 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13493 level "admin".
13494
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013495enable agent <backend>/<server>
13496 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13497
13498 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13499 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13500
13501 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13502 level "admin".
13503
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013504enable frontend <frontend>
13505 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13506 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13507 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13508 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13509 which was disabled.
13510
13511 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13512 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13513
13514 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13515 level "admin".
13516
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013517enable health <backend>/<server>
13518 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13519 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13520
13521 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13522 level "admin".
13523
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013524enable server <backend>/<server>
13525 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13526 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13527
13528 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013529 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013530
13531 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13532 level "admin".
13533
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013534get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013535get acl <acl> <value>
13536 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13537 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13538 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13539 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13540 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013541
13542 The first two words are:
13543
13544 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13545 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13546 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13547
13548 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13549
13550 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13551
13552 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13553
13554 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13555 interpretation of the case.
13556
13557 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13558 useful with regular expressions.
13559
13560 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13561 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13562
13563 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13564 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13565 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13566
13567 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13568
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013569get weight <backend>/<server>
13570 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13571 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13572 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13573 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13574 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013575 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013576
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013577help
13578 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13579 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013580
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013581prompt
13582 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13583 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13584 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13585 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13586 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13587 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13588 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13589 command.
13590
13591quit
13592 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013593
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013594set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013595 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13596 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13597 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013598
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013599set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013600 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13601 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13602 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13603 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13604 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013605 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13606 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13607
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013608set maxconn global <maxconn>
13609 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13610 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13611 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13612 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13613 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13614 setting.
13615
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013616set rate-limit connections global <value>
13617 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13618 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13619 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13620 is passed in number of connections per second.
13621
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013622set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13623 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13624 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013625 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13626 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013627
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013628set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13629 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13630 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13631 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13632 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13633
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013634set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13635 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13636 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13637 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13638 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13639 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13640
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013641set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13642 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13643 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13644 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13645
13646set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13647 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13648 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13649 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13650
13651set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13652 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13653 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13654 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13655 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13656 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13657 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13658 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13659 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13660
13661set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13662 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13663 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13664
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013665set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13666 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13667 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13668 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13669 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13670
13671 Example:
13672 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13673 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13674 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13675 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13676
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013677set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013678 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13679 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13680 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13681 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013682 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13683 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013684
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013685set timeout cli <delay>
13686 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13687 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13688 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13689
13690set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13691 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13692 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013693 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13694 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13695 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13696 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13697 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13698 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13699 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13700 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13701 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13702 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13703 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13704 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13705 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013706
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013707show errors [<iid>]
13708 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13709 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013710 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13711 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13712 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013713
13714 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13715 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13716 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13717 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13718 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13719 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13720 are reported too.
13721
13722 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13723 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13724 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13725 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13726 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13727 code.
13728
13729 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13730 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13731 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13732 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13733 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13734 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13735 line.
13736
13737 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013738 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13739 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013740 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13741 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13742
13743 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13744 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13745 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13746 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13747 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13748 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13749 00204+ minal\r\n
13750 00211 \r\n
13751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013752 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013753 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13754 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13755 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13756 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13757 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13758 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013759
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013760show info
13761 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13762
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013763show map [<map>]
13764 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013765 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13766 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13767 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13768 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13769 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13770 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013771
13772show acl [<acl>]
13773 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013774 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13775 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13776 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13777 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13778 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013779
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013780show pools
13781 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13782 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13783 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13784 the pools.
13785
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013786show sess
13787 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013788 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13789 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13790
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013791show sess <id>
13792 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13793 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13794 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13795 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13796 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013797 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13798 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13799
13800 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13801 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013802
13803show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13804 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13805 possible to dump only selected items :
13806 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13807 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13808 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13809 for example:
13810 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13811 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13812 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13813
13814 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013815 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13816 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013817 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13818 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13819 Nbproc: 1
13820 Process_num: 1
13821 (...)
13822
13823 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13824 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13825 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13826 (...)
13827 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13828
13829 $
13830
13831 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13832 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13833 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13834 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013835 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013836
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013837show table
13838 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13839 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13840 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13841 entries currently in use.
13842
13843 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013844 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013845 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13846 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013847
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013848show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013849 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13850 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13851 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013852 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13853
13854 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13855 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13856 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13857 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13858 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13859
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013860 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13861 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13862 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13863 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13864 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13865 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13866
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013867
13868 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013869 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13870 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013871
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013872 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013873 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013874 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013875 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13876 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13877 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13878 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013879
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013880 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013881 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013882 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13883 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013884
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013885 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13886 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013887 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013888 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13889 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013890
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013891 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13892 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013893 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013894 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13895 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13896
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013897 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13898 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13899 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13900 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13901 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13902
13903 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13904 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13905 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013906 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13907 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013908 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13909 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013910
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013911shutdown frontend <frontend>
13912 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13913 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13914 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13915 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13916 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13917 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13918 once it is terminated.
13919
13920 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13921 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13922
13923 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13924 level "admin".
13925
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013926shutdown session <id>
13927 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13928 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13929 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13930 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13931 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13932 flag in the logs.
13933
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020013934shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013935 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13936 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13937 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13938 'K' flag in the logs.
13939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013940/*
13941 * Local variables:
13942 * fill-column: 79
13943 * End:
13944 */